Ametek Gemco Price List
 
BPI Home Page
Aero-Motive P/L
Ametek Gemco P/L
Cutler-Hammer P/L
Eldro P/L
 
Part No Description Price
USD
004560058 Ametek Gemco Screw on a 1025D Foot & Palm Switch Item 5 1/8 $2.00
014570001 Ametek Gemco Bearing 3/4 (Inch Bore with Flanges $24.92
01533002L100 Ametek Gemco Cable. 100 Foot Bulk Resolver Cable for single Turn Resolvers, 22 AWG., 4 twisted Pairs with shield Price per foot / $ 2.00 Add length required at the end of the part number for other lengths (15LB)01/11 $200.00
01533002L2000 Ametek Gemco Cable. 2000 Foot Bulk Resolver Cable for single Turn Resolvers, 22 AWG., 4 twisted Pairs with shield Price per foot / $ 2.00 Add length required at the end of the part number for other lengths (15LB) $4,000.00
01533002L300 Ametek Gemco Cable. 300 Foot Bulk Resolver Cable for single Turn Resolvers, 22 AWG., 4 twisted Pairs with shield Price per foot / $ 2.00 Add length required at the end of the part number for other lengths $600.00
01533002LXX Ametek Gemco Cable. Bulk Resolver Cable for single Turn Resolvers, 22 AWG., 4 twisted Pairs with shield Price per foot. Add length required at the end of the part number XXX (<5LB) $2.00
01533114LXX Ametek Gemco Cable. Resolver Cable 22 AWG., 3 Twisted Pair with Shield. Priced per Foot $2.00
01591317 Ametek Gemco Fluid. Shell Transformer Oil. Standard Fluid for ET Brake Thrusters. Diala AX Transformer Fluid. Sold per LB. About 6 pounds per thruster/ 1 Gallon 1/11 $17.00
01591318 Ametek Gemco Fluid. Silicone Fluid. Optional Fluid for ET Brake Thrusters. Wacker AK 50 US, SWS-101-50, Sold per LB, Approximately 6 LBS required per thruster assembly 1/10 $40.00
01591448 Ametek Gemco Cord. Teflon Cord, 1/8th Inch Diameter by 90 Foot Call
02546004 Ametek Coil Call
04-570256 Ametek Gemco Rod End. Female 1/4 -28 UNC Thread Front Rod End. Attaches to the rod / pistion. For use with 955D & DQ, 955LC, 956A, S, LC & DQ LDT'S $22.00
04234100 Ametek Gemco Relay, Double Pole, Double Throw, 240 Volt, 60 Hz, 25 Amp (1LB) $62.50
04234700 Ametek Gemco Relay, Double Pole, Single Throw, 240 Volt $65.00
04511310 Ametek Gemco Rectifier Part Call
04513135 Ametek Gemco EPROM. IC EPROM for a 1995-L Micro-Set Programmable Limit Switch. Programmed with ''- X '' Standard Software 128K (<1LB) $110.00
04514195 Ametek Gemco Rectifier a component on rectifier E010326 $35.00
04515173 Ametek Gemco Varistor on rectifier E010326 $20.00
04517039 Ametek Gemco Intrinsically Safe Barrier $381.00
04517214 Ametek Gemco Panel Mount Bracket for Barrier $39.00
04519072 Ametek Gemco Transformer on rectifier panel E0103026. 500 VA, 1 PH, 50 / 60 Hz, 380 to 600 Volt Primary, 115 / 230 Volt Secondary $235.70
04519135 Ametek Gemco Transformer used on a rectifier panel, 100 VA, 230 Volt PR1, 56VCT Sec., Triad FD8-56 1/10 $155.00
04521186 Ametek Gemco Terminal Strip. 16 Place Terminal Strip used on programmer and output expansion module. 1995 Micro-Set PLS (<1LB)01/11 $47.00
04521187 Ametek Gemco Terminal Strip. 24 Place Terminal Strip used on programmer and output expansion module. 1995 Micro-Set PLS (<1LB) $70.00
04521210 Ametek Gemco Cable Assembly for the 950IS only. 6 Foot 2 Pin Euro Mini Straight Connector $38.00
04521210L120 Ametek Gemco Cable Assembly for the 950IS only. 120 Foot 2 Pin Euro Mini Straight Connector Call
04521372 Ametek Gemco Connector. Mating connector for ''E'' connector configurations on 951, 952, 952QD, 953A, 953D LDT's, Female 10 Pin (<1LB)01/11 $36.00
04521410 Ametek Gemco Connector. Additional Phone Jack Interface Connector. Modular 6 Conductor with Case CSC72339B-01 (<1LB) $5.00
04521570 Gemco Connector Lock for a 955S $15.00
04521574 Ametek Gemco Connector. Cable Connector less cable, * Pin, Female (<1LB) $40.00
04521594 Ametek Gemco Cable & Connector Assembly by 10 Feet Long. Connector MS3106A18-1S CDCAV10 AMCI $210.00
04521598 Ametek Gemco Connector Assembly. Field Configurable 5 Pin M12 Connector. Attaches to a 949011L Cable Assembly 1/11 $40.00
04523020 Ametek Gemco Relay. 1996 Ram-Set & Brake Monitor Relay on a 1992 Press-Set Controller (<1LB)01/11 $37.00
04523022 Ametek Gemco Relay. Mechanical Output Relay SPDT 10 AMP, 24 VDC 1992 & 1995 PLS 01/11 $23.00
04523038 Ametek Gemco OBSOLETE NO LONGER AVAILABLE Relay, AC Sold State Relay, 1 AMP., 70 - 250 VDC Call
04523039 Ametek Gemco OBSOLETE NO LONGER AVAILABLE Relay, DC Sold State Relay, 2 AMP., 5 - 60 VDC Call
04523085 Ametek Gemco Timer on Delay used on a rectifier panel, 10 Sec Plug in, 8 Pin, 240 VAC 1/10 $215.00
04523126 Ametek Gemco Relay. AC Solid State Relay, 3 AMP., 24 - 280 VAC (<1LB) $23.00
04523127 Ametek Gemco Relay. DC Solid State Relay, 3 AMP., 5 - 60 VDC (<1LB) $23.00
04526004 Ametek Gemco Fuse. Output Relay Fuse on a 1989-O-115-A-S 1/11 $11.50
04535001 Ametek Gemco Resolver. Replacement resolver with wire leads but without connector (2LBS) with connector part SD0308900 1/11 $367.00
04535051 Ametek Gemco Resolver Call
04535076 Ametek Gemco Resolver. Single Turn Size 11 (2LBS) REV A: Black / White Wire was Yellow / White 4/25/08 $359.10
04535094 Ametek Gemco Resolver. Size 11 resolver, single shaft (internal resolver only, no housing)
11-BHW-40-F/F473
$925.00
04537001 Ametek Gemco Switch. Snap Switch SPDT. Micro Switch USA BZ-2RW822-A2 old BZ-2RW22-A2 2000 Series Unit 1/11 $36.00
04537002 Ametek Gemco Switch. Snap Switch. SPDT. Micro Switch USA BZ-2RW822-P4 1/10 $36.00
04537003 Ametek Gemco Micro Switch DPDT. Includes Roller & Arm (<1LB) 1/11 $156.00
04537004 Ametek Gemco Switch used on the 2000 Series Limit Switch Assemblies, S.P.D.T., Includes Actuator Arm with Roller and Hardware. Can be wired for normally open or closed circuit. Plunger Side Normally Open Terminals, Opposite Plunger Side Normally Closed Terminals 16-204 (<1LB) 1/10 $43.00
04537018 Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Switch with 1/2 Roller. Sq D # 9007-AB1-S1. 2000 Series GRLS 1/8 $125.00
04537080 Ametek Gemco Key for a 1992 Press-Set Controller or a 1989 PLS (<1LB) 1/11 $24.00
04538002 Ametek Gemco Heater 1/10 $104.00
04538004 Ametek Gemco Thermostats 1/11 $77.00
04560001 Ametek Gemco Screw. Pan Head Machine Screw 6-32 x 1'' STL SLTD zinc & wax taptite (<1LB)
$1.28
04562148 Ametek Gemco Jam Nut (<1LB) $5.00
04564002 Ametek Gemco Woodruff Key $0.56
04564012 Ametek Gemco Fastener. Retaining / Snap Ring. Truarc 5100-37 SZDB. Shaft to Worm Gear Fastener 200- Series $1.00
04568001 Ametek Gemco Seal. NEMA 12 Seal / Gasket on a 1980 Series Limit Switch. For the Frame Ends not the Cover, see 04568004. Cost is per Foot. Establish the length required before ordering 1/8 $6.00
04568004 Ametek Gemco Seal. NEMA 12 Seal / Gasket on a 1980 Series Limit Switch. For the Cover not the Frame Ends, see 04568001. Cost is per Foot. Establish the length required before ordering 1/8 $6.00
04570001 Ametek Gemco Bearing. Sealed Ball Bearing with Mounting Flanges for a 1980 Series Limit Switch. NEMA 1, 4 or 12 Enclosures. 3/4 Inch I.D. (1LB) 1/11 $28.00
04570252 Ametek Gemco Rod Ends for the 956 LDT or Control Arm 955ARM Female Thread 1/4 -28 $10.00
04573067 Ametek Gemco Motor 48 VDC Tach Generator, aka 902436 1/11 $103.00
04575082 Ametek Gemco Belt. Drive Belt, 126 Pin. Resolver to Tach Generator to the Drive / Main Shaft on a 1980-3853 6/9 $44.00
04578121 Ametek Gemco Repair Kit. Repair Kit for New Style Power Cluster J54085 or J054086. Includes 7 items from page 1 of the Service Instructions. Item 2 O'Ring, Item 4 Retaining Ring, Item 6 Seal, Item 9 Gasket, Item 16 Cup. Item 18 Check Valve, Item 19 Seat. This Repair Kit does NOT contain the Diaphragm (1LB) 1/11 $177.00
04578122 Ametek Gemco Diaphragm on a New Style J054085 Power Cluster.Item 2 on page 2 of Service Instructions (<1LB) $143.00
04578123 Ametek Gemco Diaphragm on a New Style J054086 Power Cluster.Item 2 on page 2 of Service Instructions (<1LB) $49.00
04580066 Ametek Gemco Coupling. .25 X .120 Bore . Used to connect the cam shaft and a resolver 1986 or 1980R (1LB) $41.00
04581003 Ametek Gemco Spring. Return Spring on a Foot Switch (<1LB) 7/7 $2.50
04581004 Ametek Gemco Spring. Return Spring on a Foot Switch (<1LB) 1/8 $3.00
04581006 Ametek Gemco Spring. Pedal Return Spring on a 1025C Foot Switch. Item no 6, 1 per Switch (<1LB) $2.34
04581008 Ametek Gemco Spring. Return Spring on a Foot Switch (<1LB) 1/8 $3.50
04582015 Ametek Gemco Belt. O-Ring Belt, Cam box main shaft to tach generator drive belt (<1LB) $2.00
0953-V0-0250-X-X-S-X Ametek Gemco Linear Displacement Transducer. Series 953 VMAX
Model 953A-V0-0250-X-X-S-X
V0 = 0 to 10 VDC Output
0250 = Stroke 25 Inch Length
X = Standard 2.0 Inch Null Zone
X = Standard Dead Band 2.5 Inch
S = 5 Pin Micro, 12 mm Euro Connector
X = No options
$720.00
10'' H 1 Ametek Gemco 10 Inch Hydraulic Type H Brake System. Provides infinitely variable progressive brake application for smooth controlled braking. 0 to 425 LBS. / FT dynamic stopping torque. Includes Qty.1, 10 Inch Hydraulic Brake Assembly, Fluid Reservoir Bleeder, Pushbutton Switch with Enclosure for operating the bleeder check valve, Control Cylinder with Foot Pedal, 100 Feet of Hydraulic Tubing, Tube Fittings, Unions, Clamps, Bushings, Brackets, Gaskets, 4 Armored Flexible Hoses & Wagner 21B DOT 3 Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid SAE1703. 10 Inch Brake Weight 93 LBS. Overall Width 19 - 7/16 Inch , Height 19 - 7/16 Inch. Please specify whether the Fluid Reservoir Bleeder is to be AC DC or manually operated. A 10 X 4 Inch Brake Wheel is not included. 7905 Actuator 222 LBS Gross $5,694.00
10'' HM 1 Ametek Gemco 10 X 4.25 Inch Hydraulic Brake System Type HM for Progressive / Controlled Stopping Torque and Parking. Torque range of 0 through 425 FT LBS. via Foot Pedal Pressure along with Spring Set Parking & Holding. Parking Torque 450 FT LBS. Includes one 10 Inch Diameter Hydraulic Brake Assembly, HM Control Unit, Parking Brake Control station with Signal Light, Foot Pedal & Control Cylinder, Fluid Reservoir / Bleeder, Bleeder Pushbutton, 150 FT Copper Hydraulic Tubing, Wagner 21B Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid, Fittings, Gaskets and Armored Flexible Hoses. Specify whether 230 VDC or 115 VAC for the bleeder operation. A manually operated bleeder is also available. Less Brake Wheel. 220 LBS Net. $10,547.00
10''-H-1 Ametek Gemco 10 Inch Hydraulic Type H Brake System. Provides infinitely variable progressive brake application for smooth controlled braking. 0 to 425 LBS. / FT dynamic stopping torque. Includes Qty.1, 10 Inch Hydraulic Brake Assembly J002926 with Actuating Cylinder J007905 , Fluid Reservoir Bleeder, Pushbutton Switch with Enclosure J010008 for operating the bleeder check valve, Control Cylinder J017616 with Foot Pedal J008219, 100 Feet of Hydraulic Tubing A055980, Tube Fittings J00086 , Unions J049087, Clamps J005138, Bushings J005137, Brackets F005780, Gaskets F17, 4 Armored Flexible Hoses J010160 & Wagner 21B DOT 3 Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid SAE1703. 10 Inch Brake Weight 93 LBS. Overall Width 19 - 7/16 Inch , Height 19 - 7/16 Inch. Please specify whether the Fluid Reservoir Bleeder is to be AC DC or manually operated. A 10 X 4 Inch Brake Wheel is not included in this price (222LBS) $5,694.00
10''-H-2 Ametek Gemco Hydraulic Brake System, Complete Type H Brake System. Infinitely Progressive Braking Torque, 0 to 400 Foot LBS via Foot Pedal Pressure based on a Maximum Pedal Pressure of 70 LBS. Includes Qty. 2, 10 Inch Hydraulic Brake Assemblies J002926, Fluid Reservoir Bleeder, Bleeder Pushbutton Station J10008, Control Cylinder J017616 with Pedal J008219, J73904 Installation Kit which includes, 150 Feet of Copper Tubing, 55 Tube Clamps, 55 Tube Bushings, 30 Tube Fittings, 5 Tube Unions, 2 Tube Tee's, Qty.6, Armored Hose Kits J010797 & 3 Gallons of Wagner 21B Brake Fluid F9314. Brake Wheels are not included. Please specify whether the Fluid Reservoir Bleeder is to be AC DC or manually via a 1/4 Turn Ball Valve (189LBS) $9,428.00
1025-1407 Ametek Gemco Foot Switch. Engineered product with a Reed Switch. Like a 1025-B-1SP-P
B = Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch
1SP = Reed Switch supplied
P = Plain Cover, covers only the enclosure 1/6
$247.20
1025-1410 Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch. Specially Engineered Type ''B'' Heavy Duty Treadle operated Foot Switch. This unit has Qty. 2, Individual Foot Switches with a Common Treadle Guard providing top & side protection from accidental operation. See catalog cover, top left switch pictured. 2, NEMA 4 Enclosures with Two Contact Blocks, 1 Single Pole Double Throw Switch in each enclosure which can be wired for either normally open or closed circuits (5LBS) 3/9 $492.00
1025-1421 Ametek Gemco Foot Switch. Type C Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Side Treadle Operated Foot Switch. 2 Single Pole Double Throw Switches. ( Each 1 N.O. - 1 N.C.) with special I.D originally done for United Airlines (7LBS) 7/11 $391.00
1025-1423 Ametek Gemco Foot Switch use new part number 1025-B-1SP-P-X $196.00
1025-A-1DP-S Ametek Gemco Foot Switch. Obsolete 4/1/06 see Type ''B'' Type ''A'' Standard Duty Treadle Operated Foot Switch, NEMA 1 Die Cast Enclosure, 1DP = One contact Block, 1 D.P.D.T. Double Pole Double Throw Switch, (2N.O. - 2 N.C.) 2 Position with Spring Return
. Includes Protective Shield to prevent accidental treadle operation. 3/4 Inch Conduit Entrance
(4LBS)Obsolete
Call
1025-A-1DP-X Ametek Gemco Foot Switch. Obsolete 4/1/06 see Type ''B'', Type ''A'' Standard Duty Treadle Operated Foot Switch, NEMA 1 Die Cast Enclosure, 1SP = One contact Block, 1 D.P.D.T. Single Pole Double Throw Switch, (2N.O. - 2 N.C.) 2 Position with Spring Return. 3/4 Inch Conduit Entrance (2LBS)Obsolete Call
1025-A-1SP-S Ametek Gemco Foot Switch. Obsolete 4/1/06 see Type ''B'' Type ''A'' Standard Duty Treadle Operated Foot Switch, NEMA 1 Die Cast Enclosure, 1SP = One contact Block, 1 S.P.D.T. Single Pole Double Throw Switch, (1N.O. - 1 N.C.) 2 Position with Spring Return. Includes Protective Shield to prevent accidental treadle operation. 3/4 Inch Conduit Entrance (4LBS)Obsolete Call
1025-A-1SP-X Ametek Gemco Foot Switch. Obsolete 4/1/06 see Type ''B'',Type ''A'' Standard Duty Treadle Operated Foot Switch, NEMA 1 Die Cast Enclosure, 1SP = One contact Block, 1 S.P.D.T. Single Pole Double Throw Switch, (1N.O. - 1 N.C.) 2 Position with Spring Return. 3/4 Inch Conduit Entrance.Obsolete Call
1025-B-1A4-S-X Ametek Gemco Foot Switch. Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Foot Switch.
1A4 = 4 Way 5 Port, 1 Air Valve
S = Treadle Shield for Top & Side Switch Protection
X = No Switch Latch
$446.00
1025-B-1DP-G-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch
B = Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch
1DP = One D.P.D.T. Double Pole Double Throw Switch which can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits, Qty. 8, Screw Terminals
G = Treadle Guard provides Top Protection from accidental operation
X = No other options (11LBS)
$250.00
1025-B-1DP-P-X Ametek Gemco Foot & Palm Switches. Series 1025 Type B Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch. 1 Contact Block 1 D.P.D.T. Switch that can be wired for a normally open or closed circuit. Only the enclosure is covered. The foot pedal is not covered (5LBS) $230.00
1025-B-1DP-S-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch
B = Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch
1DP = One D.P.D.T. Double Pole Double Throw Switch which can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits, Qty. 8, Screw Terminals
S = Treadle Shield for Top & Side Protection X = No other options
$282.00
1025-B-1DP-U-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch
B = Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch
1DP = One D.P.D.T. Double Pole Double Throw Switch which can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits, Qty. 8, Screw Terminals
U = Treadle Shield provides Top, Side and a Safety Gate which must be raised by the toe to gain access to the treadle X = No other options (11LBS)
$295.00
1025-B-1SP-G-L Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switches, Type ''B'' Heavy Duty Treadle operated foot switch. NEMA 4, Two contact blocks, 1 SPDT ( 1 NO - 1NC ) with Treadle Guard to provide top protection from accidental operation
L = Treadle Latch to permit spring return or maintained contacts operation
$257.00
1025-B-1SP-G-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switches, Type ''B'' Heavy Duty Treadle operated foot switch. NEMA 4, Two contact blocks, 1 SPDT ( 1 NO - 1NC ) with Treadle Guard to provide top protection from accidental operation (5LBS)
$216.00
1025-B-1SP-P-X Ametek Gemco Foot & Palm Switches. Series 1025 Type B Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch. 1 Contact Block 1 S.P.D.T. Switch that can be wired for a normally open or closed circuit. Only the enclosure is covered. The foot pedal is not covered (5LBS) C-H 10251H25H $196.00
1025-B-1SP-S-L Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switches, Type ''B'' Heavy Duty Treadle Operated Foot Switch. NEMA 4, One contact block, 1 SPDT ( One 1 NO - 1NC ), S Cover Option = Treadle Shield provides Top & Side Protection L = Treadle Latch (8LBS) $289.00
1025-B-1SP-S-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switches, Type ''B'' Heavy Duty Treadle Operated Foot Switch. NEMA 4, One contact block, 1 SPDT ( One 1 NO - 1NC ), S Cover Option = Treadle Shield provides Top & Side Protection C-H 10251-H35C with Switch Type B (8LBS)
$248.00
1025-B-1SP-U-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switches, Type ''B'' Heavy Duty Treadle Operated Foot Switch. NEMA 4, One contact block, 1 SPDT ( One 1 NO - 1NC ), U Cover Option = Treadle Shield provides Top, Side and a Safety Gate which must be raised by the toe to gain access to the treadle (11LBS) $261.00
1025-B-2DP-P-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch
B = Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch
2DP = Two D.P.D.T. Double Pole Double Throw Switches which can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits
X = No other options
$265.00
1025-B-2DP-S-L Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch.
B = Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch
2DP = Two D.P.D.T. Double Pole Double Throw Switches which can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits
S = Treadle Shield for Top & Side Protection
L = Protective Shield
$358.00
1025-B-2DP-S-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switches, Type ''B'' Heavy Duty Treadle operated foot switch. NEMA 4, Two contact blocks, 2 DPDT ( Each 2 NO - 2NC ) with Treadle Shield providing Top & Side Guard protection from accidental operation (8LBS) $317.00
1025-B-2DP-U-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch
B = Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch
2DP = Two D.P.D.T. Double Pole Double Throw Switches which can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits
U = Ultra Guard with Treadle Shield & Safety Gate which must be raised by the toe to gain access to the treadle
X = no other options available
$330.00
1025-B-2SP-G-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switches, Type ''B'' Heavy Duty Treadle operated foot switch. NEMA 4, Two contact blocks, 2 SPDT ( Each 1 NO - 1NC ) with Treadle Guard to provide top protection from accidental operation $250.00
1025-B-2SP-P-X Ametek Gemco Foot & Palm Switches. Series 1025 Type B Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch. 2 Contact Blocks, 2 S.P.D.T. Switches that can be wired for a normally open or closed circuits. Only the enclosure is covered. The foot pedal is not covered (5LBS) $230.00
1025-B-2SP-S-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch.
B = Heavy Duty Treadle Operated Foot Switch with a NEMA 4 Enclosure / Weatherproof
2SP = Two S.P.D.T. Single Pole Double Throw Switches which can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits
S = Shield, Treadle Shield that provides both Top & Side Protection from unintentional operation
X = No other options (8LBS)
$282.00
1025-B-2SP-U-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch
B = Heavy Duty NEMA 4 Treadle Operated Foot Switch
2SP = Two S.P.D.T. Single Pole Double Throw Switches which can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits
U = Ultra Guard with Treadle Shield & Safety Gate which must be raised by the toe to gain access to the treadle
X = no other options available
$295.00
1025-C-2DP-S Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch, Type C Heavy Duty Side Treadle, NEMA 4 Water and Oiltight Enclosure has a Die Cast Aluminum Case, Cover & Treadle. Two Contact Blocks, 2 D.P.D.T. Switches (Each 2 NO - 2 NC) with Protective Shields. Six nameplates are provided, ''START'' ''STOP'' ''FORWARD'' ''REVERSE'' two are blank for special markings. Case has Qty. 2, 3/4'' pipe tapped conduit entrances one of which is fitted with a pipe plug. (12LBS) $460.00
1025-C-2DP-X Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch, Type C Heavy Duty Side Treadle, NEMA 4 Water and Oiltight Enclosure has a Die Cast Aluminum Case & Treadle. Two Contact Blocks, 2 D.P.D.T. Switches (Each 2 NO - 2 NC) Six nameplates are provided, ''START'' ''STOP'' ''FORWARD'' ''REVERSE'' two are blank for special markings. Case has Qty. 2, 3/4'' pipe tapped conduit entrances one of which is fitted with a pipe plug. (11LBS) $410.00
1025-C-2SP-S Ametek Gemco Foot Operated Switch, Type C Heavy Duty Side Treadle, NEMA 4 Water and Oiltight Enclosure has a Die Cast Aluminum Case, Cover & Treadle. Two Contact Blocks, 2 S.P.D.T. Switches (Each 1 NO - 1 NC) with Protective Shields. Six nameplates are provided, ''START'' ''STOP'' ''FORWARD'' ''REVERSE'' two are blank for special markings. Case has Qty. 2, 3/4'' pipe tapped conduit entrances one of which is fitted with a pipe plug (11LBS) $391.00
1025-C-2SP-X Ametek Gemco Switch. Foot Operated Switches, Type ''C'' Heavy Duty Side Treadle Operated Foot Switch. NEMA 4 Enclosure, Two Contact Blocks, Two Snap action Single Pole Double Throw Switches that can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits. Six Name Plates are provided. START STOP FORWARD REVERSE & Two are blank for your custom marking (7LBS) $341.00
1025-D-1SP Ametek Gemco Foot and Palm Operated Switch. Type D with a Large Orange Mushroom Button 5 Inches in Diameter which is well suited for critical applications where a large easy to see operator is required. NEMA Type 1 Enclosure has a die cast aluminum case and operating button. One S.P.D.T. Switch (1 NO - 1 NC) Case has a Qty. of 2, 3/4 inch pipe tapped conduit entrances one of which is fitted with a pipe plug (4LBS) $217.00
1025-D-2DP Ametek Gemco Foot and Palm Operated Switch. Type D with a Large Orange Mushroom Button 5 Inches in Diameter which is well suited for critical applications where a large easy to see operator is required. NEMA Type 1 Enclosure has a die cast aluminum case and operating button. Two D.P.D.T. Switch (2 NO - 2 NC) Case has a Qty. of 2, 3/4 inch pipe tapped conduit entrances one of which is fitted with a pipe plug (4LBS) $284.00
1025-D-2SP Ametek Gemco Foot and Palm Operated Switch. Type D with a Large Orange Mushroom Button 5 Inches in Diameter which is well suited for critical applications where a large easy to see operator is required. NEMA Type 1 Enclosure has a die cast aluminum case and operating button. One D.P.D.T. Switch (2 NO - 2 NC) Case has a Qty. of 2, 3/4 inch pipe tapped conduit entrances one of which is fitted with a pipe plug (4LBS) $251.00
10316H-169-1 Ametek Gemco 2006-402-L-1080-A $457.00
10316H89A Ametek Gemco 1950-1-B-A-DO C-H Part # shown above $30.00
104A020XXXX Ametek Gemco Thermistors. 9967 LUG Thermistor. MOTOGARD Controllers are designed for use with Positive Temperature Coefficient Thermistors. Thermistor is encapsulated in a special epoxy for rugged mechanical duty, severe environments and good thermal conductivity# 22 - 26 Teflon Insulated Leads. Specify desired length of the leads (<1LB) Call
104A022XXXX Ametek Gemco Thermistors. 9967 SPRING LOADED PROBE Thermistor. MOTOGARD Controllers are designed for use with Positive Temperature Coefficient Thermistors. Thermistor is encapsulated in a special epoxy for rugged mechanical duty, severe environments and good thermal conductivity# 22 - 26 Teflon Insulated Leads. 7/16 Inch Diameter. 1/4 Inch NPT. Specify desired probe length, 2 to 6 Inches is standard. Specify lead length (<1LB) Call
107085 Ametek Gemco Repair Kit, for a Moisture Ejection Valve. ISG SAP 1170357 $50.11
107163002 Ametek Gemco Pressure Cluster Assembly, 1 X 8, with special piston for long static lines, like 54086 $546.00
1090-A1 Ametek Gemco Obsolete 12 Bit unit. Replaced by 1090B1 a 14 Bit unit Call
1090B1 Ametek Gemco Multibus High Speed Programmable Limit Switch. 14 Bit Resolution. Replaced 1090A1 $3,648.00
115101-2 Ametek Gemco MOTOGARD 9966. Series 115 Over Temperature Protection System. 6 Inputs, 2 Triac Outputs 1-N.O. 1 N.C. Input Rating: 120 VAC + or - 10% Single Phase 50/60 Hz. Output Rating: 120 /240 Volts 5 amp continuous. Reset is automatic. Enclosure 5.5'' Wide X 4.25'' Long X 3.12'' High Potted in a NEMA 4 Steel Case (5LBS) $396.00
120101 Ametek Gemco MOTOGARD 9966. Series 120 Over Temperature Protection System $242.00
135101 Ametek Gemco MOTOGARD 9966. Series 135 Over Temperature Protection System $483.00
14'' H 2 Ametek Gemco 14 Inch Hydraulic Brake System, Qty. 2, Brake Assemblies each capable of 0 to 600 LBS / FT Torque, Control Cylinder, Pedal, Fluid Reservoir Bleeder, 250 Foot of Tubing, 6 Armored Hoses, 3 Gallons of 21B Wagner Brake Fluid and Fittings, 6 Brackets, 6 Jam Nuts, 36 Tube Nuts, 6 Lock Washers, 15 Copper Gaskets, 85 Bushings, 85 Clamps, 7 Unions for a complete system, less brake wheels $11,337.00
14'' HM 1 Ametek Gemco 14 X 6.50 Inch Hydraulic Brake System Type HM for Progressive / Controlled Stopping Torque and Parking. Torque range of 0 through 600 FT LBS. via Foot Pedal Pressure along with Spring Set Parking & Holding. Parking Torque 550 FT LBS. Includes one 14 Inch Diameter Hydraulic Brake Assembly, HM Control Unit, Parking Brake Control Station with Signal Light, Foot Pedal & Control Cylinder, Fluid Reservoir / Bleeder, Bleeder Pushbutton, 150 FT Copper Hydraulic Tubing, Wagner 21B Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid, Fittings, Gaskets and Armored Flexible Hoses. Specify whether 230 VDC or 115 VAC for the bleeder operation. A manually operated bleeder is also available. Less Brake Wheel. 289 LBS Net $11,436.00
14''-H-1 Ametek Gemco 14 Inch Hydraulic Type H Brake System. Provides infinitely variable progressive brake application for smooth controlled braking. 0 to 600 LBS. / FT dynamic stopping torque. Includes Qty.1, 14 Inch Hydraulic Brake Assembly, DC Fluid Reservoir Bleeder, Control Cylinder with Foot Pedal, 100 Feet of Hydraulic Tubing, Tube Fittings, Unions, Clamps, Bushings, Brackets, Gaskets, 4 Armored Flexible Hoses & Wagner 21B DOT 3 Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid SAE1703. 14 Inch Brake Weight 161 LBS. Overall Width 25 - 7/8 Inch, Height 28 - 1/2 Inch. A 7905 Brake Actuator is provided / used on a single brake system (320LBS) $6,648.00
150101 Ametek Gemco MOTOGARD 9966. Series 150 Over Temperature Protection Systems provide immediate overheating protection for motors equipment enclosures, semiconductor heatsinks, sleeve bearings and other related machinery. For use with PTC Thermistors embedded in or in contact with the monitored surface. 1 Input, Form C Relay Output. 2 Triac Outputs 1-N.O. 1 N.C. Input Rating: 120 VAC + or - 10% Single Phase 50/60 Hz. Output Rating: 120 VAC for size 5 contactor coil. Reset is automatic. Enclosure 3.25'' Wide X 2.25'' Long X 2.50'' High. Potted in a polyester case. Conforms with NEC Requirements for integral motor thermal protection (1LB) $191.00
16-204 Ametek Gemco Switch see AME-04537004 ITW-16-204 (<1LB) $34.00
17-1808181 Cutler-Hammer Frame. Cast Brake Frame for a 8.5 or 10 Inch Series 511 Solenoid Brake. Not sure which Call
1746L-1 Ametek Gemco LDT Interface Card. Single Axis, One LDT Input. Specify LDT output if other than: CP, VPI or RS (2LBS) $1,250.00
1746L-2 Ametek Gemco LDT Interface Card. Two Axis, Two LDT Inputs. Specify LDT output if other than: CP, VPI or RS (2LBS) $1,996.00
1746R-1 Ametek Gemco Interface Card. Series 1746R Resolver Interface Card incorporates Allen-Bradley licensed technology for complete compatibility with A-B Series 1746 I/O Chassis. The unit monitors machine position from a resolver and delivers continues absolute position data at 12 bit (4,096 count) resolution and RPM data to the SLC processor. $1,250.00
1746R-2 Ametek Gemco Interface Card. Series 1746R Resolver Interface Card incorporates Allen-Bradley licensed technology for complete compatibility with A-B Series 1746 I/O Chassis. The unit monitors machine position from a resolver and delivers continues absolute position data at 12 bit (4,096 count) resolution and RPM data to the SLC processor. Two axis resolver interface. Two resolver inputs or field configurable for one multi-turn dual resolver. $1,588.00
17618 Ametek Gemco Washer on Spring Case Gasket Kit $0.26
1771-PLS-B1 Ametek Gemco Ultra-High Speed Programmable Limit Switch (PLS) with 16 direct outputs from the front panel that update every 5 microseconds. A resolver based unit that incorporated Allen-Bradley technology and is completely compatible with the A-B Series 1771 I/O chassis. Internally powered by the PLC backplane. Resolver input with 14 bit (16,384 count) resolution and field programmable scale factor. Reset to Preset Inputs & Speed Compensation. This product incorporates patented technology which is licensed by Allen -Bradley Company Inc. Allen-Bradley is a registered trademark of Rockwell Corporation (3LBS) $6,951.00
1771-PLS-C1 Ametek Gemco Programmable Limit Switch. Allen Bradley Series 1771 Compatible High Speed Programmable Limit Switch. Standard 14 Bit Resolution (4LBS) $4,210.00
18'' H-2 Ametek Gemco Hydraulic Brake System, Complete Type H Brake System. Infinitely Progressive Braking Torque, 0 to 1800 Foot LBS via Foot Pedal Pressure based on a Maximum Pedal Pressure of 70 LBS. Includes Qty. 2, 18 Inch Hydraulic Brake Assemblies J002932, Fluid Reservoir Bleeder, Bleeder Pushbutton Station J10008, Control Cylinder J017616 with Pedal J008219, Installation Kits J07300 &J073903 which includes, 250 Feet of Copper Tubing, 85 Tube Clamps, 85 Tube Bushings, 36 Tube Fittings, 7 Tube Unions, 1 Tube Tee, Qty.6, Armored Hose Kits J010797 & 4 Gallons of Wagner 21B Brake Fluid F9314. Brake Wheels are not included. Please specify whether the Fluid Reservoir Bleeder is to be AC DC or manually via a 1/4 Turn Ball Valve (670LBS) $14,092.00
18'' HM 1 Ametek Gemco 18 X 8.50 Inch Hydraulic Brake System Type HM for Progressive / Controlled Stopping Torque and Parking. Torque range of 0 through 900 FT LBS. via Foot Pedal Pressure along with Spring Set Parking & Holding. Parking Torque 700 FT LBS. Includes one 18 Inch Diameter Hydraulic Brake Assembly, HM Control Unit, Parking Brake Control Station with Signal Light, Foot Pedal & Control Cylinder, Fluid Reservoir / Bleeder, Bleeder Pushbutton, 150 FT Copper Hydraulic Tubing, Wagner 21B Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid, Fittings, Gaskets and Armored Flexible Hoses. Specify whether 230 VDC or 115 VAC for the bleeder operation. A manually operated bleeder is also available. Less Brake Wheel. 389 LBS Net. $12,834.00
18''-H-1 Ametek Gemco Hydraulic Brake System, Complete Type H Brake System. Infinitely Progressive Braking Torque, 0 to 900 Foot LBS via Foot Pedal Pressure based on a Maximum Pedal Pressure of 70 LBS. Includes Qty.1, 18 Inch Hydraulic Brake Assembly J002932, Fluid Reservoir Bleeder, Bleeder Pushbutton Station J10008, Control Cylinder J017616 with Pedal J008219, J73901 Installation Kit which includes, 100 Feet of Copper Tubing, 35 Tube Clamps, 35 Tube Bushings, 14 Tube Nuts J000086, 3 Tube Unions J049087, Tube Tee, Qty.4, Armored Hose Kits J010797 & 3, 1 Gallon Cans of Wagner 21B Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid F9314. A Brake Wheel is not included. Please specify whether the Fluid Reservoir Bleeder is to be AC DC or manually via a 1/4 Turn Ball Valve. DC All same cost (359LBS) $8,026.00
1950-1-B-A-AO Ametek Gemco Switch
1950 = Precision, Snap Action, Switch Assembly Mfg by Gemco
1 = Single Pole Double Throw / S.P.D.T., Four Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuit
B = Binder / Screw Terminals 4
A = Front Mounting
AO = Switch Plunger operated via cam or roller follower
U.L. Listed, 15 AMPS, 110 - 600 Volts AC / DC
-50 to 185 Degree F
Recommended replacement @ 15 million cycles
(<1LB)
$36.00
1950-1-B-A-AR Ametek Gemco Switch
1950 = Precision, Snap Action, Switch Assembly Mfg by Gemco
1 = Single Pole Double Throw / S.P.D.T., Four Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuit
B = Binder / Screw Terminals 4
A = Front Mounting
A = Switch Plunger operated via cam or roller follower
R = Rubber boot for addition protection form humidity and dust
U.L. Listed, 15 AMPS, 110 - 600 Volts AC / DC
-50 to 185 Degree F
Recommended replacement @ 15 million cycles
(<1LB)
$58.00
1950-1-B-A-BO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit, Single Pole Double Throw (S.P.D.T.), 1 NO - 1NC Contacts, Front Mounting, Lever & 1/2'' Dia. Roller Assembly $61.00
1950-1-B-A-BR Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Action Switch with a Lever Arm / Operator and a 1/2 Diameter Roller (<1LB) $79.00
1950-1-B-A-DO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Action Switch Assembly. SPDT Single Pole Double Throw, Qty. 4 Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuit, Front Mounting, Plunger Push Operator, 2006 Type K, U.L. Listed (<1LB) $36.00
1950-1-B-A-DR Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Action Switch Assembly. 1 = Single Pole Double Throw / S.P.D.T., Four Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuit, B = Binder Terminals, A = Front Mounting, DR = Plunger with Boot, Push Operated, U.L. Listed (<1LB) $58.00
1950-1-B-B-BO Ametek Gemco Switch
1950 = Precision, Snap Action, Switch Assembly Mfg by Gemco
1 = Single Pole Double Throw / S.P.D.T., Four Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuits
B = Binder / Screw Terminals 4
B = Side Mounting Arrangement
DO = Plunger Push Operator, Cycl-Set and 2006 K RS
U.L. Listed, 15 AMPS, 110 - 600 Volts AC / DC
-50 to 185 Degree F
Recommended replacement @ 15 million cycles
(<1LB)
$64.00
1950-1-C-A-BO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit, Single Pole Double Throw (S.P.D.T.), 1 NO - 1NC Contacts, 915 / 917 Cycl-Set Terminals, Front Mount, Lever & 1/2 Inch Diameter Roller Assembly. $72.00
1950-1-C-A-DO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Action Limit Switch Assembly, Single Pole Double Throw / S.P.D.T., 4 screw terminals, can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits. Front Mount, Plunger Push Operator. 915 / 917 Cycl-Set & 2006 K RS (<1LB) $47.00
1950-1-D-A-AO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit, Single Pole Double Throw (S.P.D.T.), 1 NO - 1NC Contacts, Saddle Clamp Terminals, Front Mounting, Plunger Cam Operated $51.00
1950-1-D-A-DO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit, Single Pole Double Throw (S.P.D.T.), 1 NO - 1NC Contacts, Saddle Clamp Terminals, Front Mounting, Plunger Push Operator ( Cycl-Set & 2006K RS ) $51.00
1950-1-P-A-AO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit, Single Pole Double Throw (S.P.D.T.), 1 NO - 1NC Contacts, Plug-In Terminals, Front Mounting, Plunger Cam Operated $44.00
1950-1-P-A-AR Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit, Single Pole Double Throw (S.P.D.T.), 1 NO - 1NC Contacts, Plug-In Terminals, Front Mounting, Plunger Cam Operated, Plunger with boot-cam operator. $66.00
1950-1404 Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit. Single Pole Double Throw (S.P.D.T.) Plunger OP Binder Terminals with Boot and Heavy Springs. For use with the Series 1970 Drive Cheks (<1LB) $47.00
1950-1405 Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit. Double Pole Double Throw, Plunger Operated. Binder Terminals with Heavy Springs. 1970 Drive Chek (<1LB) $75.00
1950-1406 Ametek Gemco Switch. Obsoleted in 2006, See 1950-1413. Precision SPST Slow Make - Slow Break Switch Assembly. N.C. Normally Closed. Special Purpose Switch. U.L. Listed For the 1980 Product Line (<1LB)Obsolete $72.00
1950-1408 Ametek Gemco Switch. SPDT Slow Make Slow Break. For products 915 / 917/ 2006 (<1LB) $71.00
1950-1412 See 1950-1-B-A-A0 195-1412 is an old number $33.00
1950-1413 Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Slow Make - Slow Break Single Pole Double Throw Switch Assembly. Can be wire for either a normally open or normally close circuit. 4 screw terminals on this switch. Replaces 1950-1406 which is obsolete (<1LB) $82.00
1950-1414 Ametek Gemco Switch. Single Pole Double Throw with a Heavy Duty Spring for high vibration applications. Can be wired for normally open or closed circuits, 4 screw terminals. Replaces obsolete 1950-1416 but is not a Slow Make Slow Break Switch (<1LB) $49.00
1950-1415 Ametek Gemco Double Pole Snap Switch 1/11 $69.00
1950-1416 Ametek Gemco Switch. Obsolete 1/6 Precision Snap Switch, Single Pole Single Throw, Slow Make Slow Break with a Heavy duty / strong Spring for High Vibration Applications. Only one contact that is Normally Closed. Replaced by 1950-1414, though it is NOT an exact duplicate replacement, see specifications (<1LB)Obsolete $66.00
1950-1420 Ametek Gemco OBSOLETE Module, 4X20mH Module for an older LDT Call
1950-4-B-A-AO Ametek Gemco Switch
1950 = Precision, Snap Action, Switch Assembly Mfg by Gemco
4 = Double Pole Double Throw / D.P.D.T., Eight Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuits
B = Binder / Screw Terminals 8
A = Front Mounting
AO = Switch Plunger operated via cam or roller follower
U.L. Listed, 15 AMPS, 110 - 600 Volts AC / DC
-50 to 185 Degree F
Recommended replacement @ 15 million cycles
(<1LB)
$71.00
1950-4-B-A-AR Ametek Gemco Switch
1950 = Precision, Snap Action, Switch Assembly Mfg by Gemco
4 = Double Pole Double Throw / D.P.D.T., Eight Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuits
B = Binder / Screw Terminals 8
A = Front Mounting
A = Switch Plunger operated via cam or roller follower
R = Rubber boot for addition protection form humidity and dust
U.L. Listed, 15 AMPS, 110 - 600 Volts AC / DC
-50 to 185 Degree F
Recommended replacement @ 15 million cycles
(<1LB)
$93.00
1950-4-B-A-BR Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit. Double Pole Double Throw (D.P.D.T.) 2-NO / 2-NC, Plunger operated by Lever & 1/2 Inch Diameter Roller Assembly. Includes Boot $114.00
1950-4-B-A-DO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Action Switch Assembly. DPDT Double Pole Double Throw, Qty. 8 Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuit, Front Mounting, Plunger Push Operator, 2006 Type K, U.L. Listed (<1LB) $71.00
1950-4-B-B-BO Ametek Gemco Switch 1950-4-B-B-BO
1950 = Precision, Snap Action, Switch Assembly Mfg by Gemco
4 = Double Pole Double Throw / D.P.D.T., Eight Screw Terminals, can be wired for either a Normally Open or Normally Close Circuits
B = Binder / Screw Terminals 4
B = Side Mounting Arrangement
BO = Lever & 1/2 Inch Diameter Roller Assembly
U.L. Listed, 15 AMPS, 110 - 600 Volts AC / DC
-50 to 185 Degree F
Recommended replacement @ 15 million cycles
(<1LB)
$99.00
1950-4-C-A-DO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Action Limit Switch Assembly. Double Pole Double Throw / D.P.D.T., Eight Screw Terminals, can be wired for either Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits.Front Mount, Plunger Push Operator. 915 / 917 Cycl-Set & 2006 K RS (<1LB) $82.00
1950-4-P-A-AO Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit. D.P.D.T. Double Pole Double Throw 2-N.O 2-N.C , Plug-In Type Binder, Front Mounting Arrangement, Plunger Cam Operated. $80.00
1950G-1-B-A-AR Ametek Gemco Switch. Precision Snap Limit Switch Unit with Gold Contacts, Single Pole Double Throw (S.P.D.T.), 1 NO - 1NC Contacts, Front Mounting, Plunger with Boot, Cam Operated U.L. Listed (<1LB) 1/8 $93.00
1970-104 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek for Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switches. For a 2 to 4 Circuit Cam Box with a NEMA 1 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive-Chek can detect a broken chain or belt via a supplied travel limit switch is a , spring loaded sub base for chain or belt tensioning and a shock and vibration isolator (9LBS) $239.00
1970-106 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek for Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switches. For a 5 to 6 Circuit Cam Box with a NEMA 1 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive-Chek can detect a broken chain or belt via a supplied travel limit switch is a , spring loaded sub base for chain or belt tensioning and a shock and vibration isolator (13LBS) $261.00
1970-108 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek for Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switches. For a 7 to 8 Circuit Cam Box with a NEMA 1 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive-Chek can detect a broken chain or belt via a supplied travel limit switch is a , spring loaded sub base for chain or belt tensioning and a shock and vibration isolator (16LBS) $285.00
1970-112 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek for Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switches. For a 9 to 12 Circuit Cam Box with a NEMA 1 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive-Chek can detect a broken chain or belt via a supplied travel limit switch is a , spring loaded sub base for chain or belt tensioning and a shock and vibration isolator (19LBS) $328.00
1970-116 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek for Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switches. For a 13 to 16 Circuit Cam Box with a NEMA 1 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive-Chek can detect a broken chain or belt via a supplied travel limit switch is a , spring loaded sub base for chain or belt tensioning and a shock and vibration isolator $383.00
1970-120 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek for Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switches. For a 17 or 20 Circuit Cam Box with a NEMA 1 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive-Chek serves 3 purposes; a broken chain or belt detector via a supplied travel limit switch, spring loaded sub base for chain or belt tensioning and a shock and vibration isolator $452.00
1970-1204 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek. Drive Check for a Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switch with 2 to 4 Circuit Frame and a NEMA 4 or 12 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive Chek has a snap switch attached to the frame for detection of a broken chain or belt, it also acts as a chain or belt tensioner and absorbs some shock and vibration $261.00
1970-1206 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek. Drive Check for a Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switch with 5 to 6 Circuit Frame and a NEMA 4 or 12 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive Chek has a snap switch attached to the frame for detection of a broken chain or belt, it also acts as a chain or belt tensioner and absorbs some shock and vibration $279.00
1970-1208 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek. Drive Check for a Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switch with 7 to 8 Circuit Frame and a NEMA 4 or 12 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive Chek has a snap switch attached to the frame for detection of a broken chain or belt, it also acts as a chain or belt tensioner and absorbs some shock and vibration $310.00
1970-1212 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek. Drive Check for a Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switch with 10 to 12 Circuit Frame and a NEMA 4 or 12 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive Chek has a snap switch attached to the frame for detection of a broken chain or belt, it also acts as a chain or belt tensioner and absorbs some shock and vibration $350.00
1970-124 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek for Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switches. For a 21 to 24 Circuit Frame with a NEMA 1 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Unit serves 3 purposes; a broken chain or belt detector, a chain or belt tightener and a shock or vibration isolator $535.00
1970-1328 Ametek Gemco Drive Chek for Series 2006 Geared Rotary Limit Switches. For a 4 Circuit Switch 404, NEMA 1 Enclosure. The Drive-Chek is a multi-purpose sub base that is mounted under a chain or drive belt driven mechanism. The Drive-Chek can detect a broken chain or belt via a supplied travel limit switch is a , spring loaded sub base for chain or belt tensioning and a shock and vibration isolator (9LBS) $252.00
1980 Ametek Gemco Series 1980 Micro-Adjust Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees without a Tool - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Model 1980-106-R-DP-X
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
6 = Qty. 6, Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension
DP = DPDT Switches = Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or timing dial window

CAPE MAY NEW JERSEY MOVEABLE BRIDGE;
Specification for rotating cam limit switch.

The contractor shall provide a rotating cam limit switch that meets the specification as called out below.
The cam box shall have 16 circuits each consisting of a micro adjust cam capable of dwells from 4 degrees through 356 degrees utilizing two cam halves.
The cams shall be adjusted by use of a cam adjustment tool supplied with the cam box and mounted inside of the enclosure on a bracket.
The cams are adjusted through a 36:1 ratio pinion assembly that will rotate each half of a circuit cam 10 degrees for each complete adjustment hub turn.
The micro-adjust cams shall maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree.
Each circuit shall have a precision rugged duty snap action switch with double break contacts that are actuated at a uniform rate to give long life.
Electrical switches shall be SPDT with one NO and one NC contact per switch.
Switches shall be rated for at least 15 million cycles.
The input shaft shall be a 3/4'' diameter made of 316 Stainless Steel having a # 606 woodruff key and can be located on the right end, left end or a double ended version can be specified.
The enclosure, cover, latches, bearing flanges and flange bolts shall be constructed of 304 Stainless Steel meeting a NEMA 4X rating.
The cam box shall utilize lifetime sealed ball bearings for the input shaft.
The cam box shall be supplied standard with a three year warranty covering the entire unit.
The cam box shall be manufactured by Ametek APT, Gemco division out of Clawson Michigan with no substitutions allowed.
Call
1980-101-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-101-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
01 = 1 Independent Cam / Circuit / Switch
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(10LBS)
$511.00
1980-102-L-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-102-L-DP-X
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switch U.L. Listed
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Warranty
(11 LBS)
$632.00
1980-102-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-102-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(11LBS)
$568.00
1980-102-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-102-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$568.00
1980-102-X-SP-X-R-60-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-102-X-SP-X-R-60-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
2 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
60 = 60 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,327.00
1980-103-D-DP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-103-D-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extensions from Enclosure, 2
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch, # 1950-4-B-A-AO
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(13LBS)
$953.00
1980-103-L-DP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-103-L-DP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(11LBS)
$899.00
1980-103-L-DP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-103-L-DP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(11LBS)
$899.00
1980-103-L-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-103-L-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$718.00
1980-103-L-GSP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-103-L-GSP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension
GSP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch. With Gold Plated Contacts
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
Call
1980-103-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-103-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(11LBS)
$622.00
1980-103-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-103-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03= 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for Clockwise Rotation
3 Year Warranty
(12LBS)
$803.00
1980-103-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-103-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03= 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(12LBS)
$622.00
1980-104-D-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-D-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extensions from Enclosure, 2
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(13LBS)
$864.00
1980-104-D-DPP-R-X-S-200-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-D-DPP-R-X-S-200-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box, Double Shaft 2
DPP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch with a Plug in Socket
R = Rubber boot Option on the switch plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
$2,179.00
1980-104-D-GSP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-104-L-GSP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension
GSPR = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch. With Gold Plated Contacts & Rubber Seals for additional dust & moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided (12LBS)
Call
1980-104-D-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-D-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shafts Extending from Enclosure, 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(14LBS)
$917.00
1980-104-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Double, 2 Shaft Extensions from the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$736.00
1980-104-L-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$810.00
1980-104-L-GSP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-L-GSP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension
GSP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch. With Gold Plated Contacts
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
Call
1980-104-L-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-L-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$730.00
1980-104-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for Clockwise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(14LBS)
$863.00
1980-104-L-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-L-SP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clockwise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(14LBS)
$863.00
1980-104-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$682.00
1980-104-R-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-R-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$810.00
1980-104-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$730.00
1980-104-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$863.00
1980-104-R-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-R-SP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(10LBS)
$863.00
1980-104-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$682.00
1980-104-X-DP-X-R-18-R2 AME-1980-104-X-DP-X-R-18-R2 $1,569.00
1980-104-X-DP-X-R-24-R2 AME-1980-104-X-DP-X-R-24-R2 $1,569.00
1980-104-X-DP-X-R-5-L2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-DP-X-R-5-L2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
L2 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 2
$1,569.00
1980-104-X-DP-X-R5-L2 1980-104-X-DP-X-R-5-L-2 $1,569.00
1980-104-X-DP-X-R5-L7 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-DP-X-R-5-L7
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
L7 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 7
$1,569.00
1980-104-X-DP-X-S-10-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-DP-X-S-10-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
10 = 10 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
(18LBS)
$1,701.00
1980-104-X-DP-X-S-1000-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-DP-X-S-1000-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
1000 = 1000 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer Location
$1,701.00
1980-104-X-DP-X-S-25-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-DP-X-S-25-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
(18LBS)
$1,701.00
1980-104-X-DPR-TD1-R30-L8 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-DPR-TD1-R24-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure, Sheet Metal Cover
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch R = Rubber Boots on the Switch Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
TD1 = Timing Dial with Counter Clock Wise Labeled Dials
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
24 = 24 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1 4 weeks to ship
$1,798.00
1980-104-X-SP-X-R-400-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SP-X-R-400-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
400 = 400 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,441.00
1980-104-X-SP-X-R-5-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SP-X-R-5-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,441.00
1980-104-X-SP-X-R-7-L7 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SP-X-R-7-L7
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
7 = 7 to 1 Gear Ratio
L7 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 7
$1,441.00
1980-104-X-SP-X-R-8-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SP-X-R-8-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,441.00
1980-104-X-SP-X-R5-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SP-X-R5-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,441.00
1980-104-X-SP-X-S-10-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SP-X-S-10-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
10 = 10 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$1,573.00
1980-104-X-SP-X-S-200-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SP-X-S-200-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$1,573.00
1980-104-X-SPR-TD1-R30-L8 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SPR-TD1-R30-L8
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure, Sheet Metal Cover
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch R = Rubber Boots on the Switch Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
TD1 = Timing Dial with Counter Clock Wise Labeled Dials
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
L8 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 8
$1,670.00
1980-105-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-105-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switches U.L. Listed
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Warranty
$1,149.00
1980-105-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-105-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(14LBS)
$968.00
1980-105-R-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-105-R-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Warranty
(14LBS)
$1,128.00
1980-105-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-105-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
(14LBS)
$1,149.00
1980-105-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-105-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$968.00
1980-105-X-SP-X-R-1-L7 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-105-X-SP-X-R-1-L7
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw Precision Snap Action Switches
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
1 = 1 to 1 Gear Ratio
L7 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 7
$1,727.00
1980-105-X-SP-X-S-14-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-105-X-SP-X-S-14-R
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
5 = 5 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
14 = 14 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$1,859.00
1980-106-D-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-D-SP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shafts Extending from Enclosure, 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(16LBS)
$1,269.00
1980-106-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(14LBS)
$1,088.00
1980-106-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(14LBS)
$1,215.00
1980-106-L-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-L-SP-TD2
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.C.Wise Rotation
3 year Warranty
$1,215.00
1980-106-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(14LBS)
$1,034.00
1980-106-R-DP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-R-DP-TD2
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switches
TD2 = Timing Dial C.C.W. Counter Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Warranty
$1,407.00
1980-106-R-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-R-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$1,226.00
1980-106-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$1,215.00
1980-106-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(14LBS)
$1,034.00
1980-106-X-DP-X-S-2-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-DP-X-S-2-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
2 = 2 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,117.00
1980-106-X-DP-X-S-4-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-DP-X-S-4-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,117.00
1980-106-X-SP-R-X-S-28-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-SP-R-X-S-28-L
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
28 = 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$1,997.00
1980-106-X-SP-R-X-S-32-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-SP-R-X-S-32-L
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
32 = 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$1,997.00
1980-106-X-SP-TD1-R30-L8 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-SP-TD1-R30-L8
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
6 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD1 = Timing Dial with Counter Clock Wise Labeled Dials
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
30 = 30 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,974.00
1980-106-X-SP-X-R-10-R2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-SP-X-R-10-R2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
10 = 10 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,793.00
1980-106-X-SP-X-R-5-L7 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-SP-X-R-5-L7
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
L7 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 7
$1,793.00
1980-106-X-SP-X-S-*-* Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-SP-X-S-*-*
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
* = * Gear Ratio to be determined
* = * Shaft Location to be determined
$1,925.00
1980-106-X-SP-X-S-200-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-SP-X-S-200-R
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$1,925.00
1980-106-X-SP-X-S-35-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-X-SP-X-S-35-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
06 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
35 = 35 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$1,925.00
1980-106-X-SPR-TD1-R30-L8 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-106-X-SPR-TD1-R30-L8
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure, Sheet Metal Cover
6 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch R = Rubber Boots on the Switch Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
TD1 = Timing Dial with Counter Clock Wise Labeled Dials
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
30 = 30 to 1 Gear Ratio
L8 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 8
$2,046.00
1980-107-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-107-L-SP-X
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
7 = 7 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
$1,166.00
1980-107-R-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-107-R-DP-X
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switches U.L. Listed
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Warranty
(14LBS)
$1,390.00
1980-107-R-SP-R-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-107-R-SP-R-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture & dust
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,431.00
1980-107-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-107-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
$1,347.00
1980-107-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-107-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(16LBS)
$1,166.00
1980-107-X-SP-X-S-6-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-107-X-SP-X-S-6-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
6 = 6 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
(22LBS)
$2,057.00
1980-108-D-SD-TW1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-R-SP-TW1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
8 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension, shafts exit from both ends of the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TW1 = Timing Dial & Dial Window is to be provided Timing Dial Degrees Labeled for Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Warranty
Dimensions, use a 9 to 12 circuit enclosure drawing
(22LBS)
$1,535.00
1980-108-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
8 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension, shafts exit from both ends of the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(17LBS)
$1,354.00
1980-108-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switches U.L. Listed
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Warranty
$1,481.00
1980-108-L-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-L-SP-TD2
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
8 = 8 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD2 = Timing Dial C.C.W. Counter Clock Wise Rotation
$1,481.00
1980-108-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(17LBS)
$1,300.00
1980-108-R-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-R-DP-X
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
4 = 8 Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
$1,556.00
1980-108-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(17LBS)
$1,300.00
1980-108-X-DP-R-X-S-8-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-X-DP-R-X-S-8-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
08 = 08 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boot on switch plunger for moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
(21LBS)
$2,543.00
1980-108-X-DP-X-S-8-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-108-X-DP-X-S-8-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
08 = 08 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,447.00
1980-109-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-109-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extensions from each end of the Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(21LBS)
$1,760.00
1980-109-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-109-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(21LBS)
$1,706.00
1980-109-X-DP-X-R-14-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-109-X-DP-X-R-14-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
14 = 14 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$2,753.00
1980-110-D-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-110-D-SP-TD1
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
10 = 10 Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension (2) from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
(21LBS)
$2,134.00
1980-110-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-110-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,080.00
1980-110-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-110-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty (21LBS)
$1,899.00
1980-110-X-SP-X-R-40-L6 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-110-X-SP-X-R-40-L6
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
40 = 40 to 1 Gear Ratio
L6 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 6
$2,658.00
1980-111-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-111-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
11= 11 Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
$2,272.00
1980-111-R-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-111-R-SP-TD2
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
11= 11 Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.C.W. Rotation
$2,272.00
1980-112-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-112-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$2,285.00
1980-112-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-112-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(29LBS)
$2,466.00
1980-112-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-112-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
$2,285.00
1980-112-X-SP-R-X-S-6-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-112-X-SP-X-S-6-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture or dust protection
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
6 = 6 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$3,320.00
1980-112-X-SP-X-R-5-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-112-X-SP-X-R-5-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R= right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Shaft Location, Position 1
(36LBS)
$3,044.00
1980-112-X-SP-X-R5-R7 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-112-X-SP-X-R-5-R7
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure, Dust Tight
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
R7 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 7 / Top of Gear Box / Left Side End View
$3,044.00
1980-112-X-SP-X-S-4-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-112-X-SP-X-S-4-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$3,176.00
1980-116-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-116-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
16 = 16 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(30LBS)
$2,961.00
1980-118-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-118-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
018 = 18 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$3,588.00
1980-118-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-118-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
018 = 18 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$3,588.00
1980-118-X-SP-TD1-S-1.5-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-118-X-SP-TD1-S-1.5-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
018 = 18 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
1.5 = 1 & 1/2 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Gear Reducer & Shaft Extension on Left End
$4,479.00
1980-118-X-SP-TD1-S-1.5-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-118-X-SP-TD1-S-1.5-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
018 = 18 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
1.5 = 1 & 1/2 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Gear Reducer & Shaft Extension on Right End
$4,479.00
1980-1202-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1202-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
02 = 2 Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
$1,040.00
1980-1202-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1202-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Gasketed / Dust Tight
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$859.00
1980-1202-X-SP-X-R4-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1202-X-SP-X-R4-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Gasketed Dust Tight
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,618.00
1980-1202-X-SP-X-R5-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1202-X-SP-X-R5-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Gasketed Dust Tight
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,618.00
1980-1202-X-SP-X-S30-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1202-X-SP-X-S30-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust Tight
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
30 = 30 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$1,750.00
1980-1203-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1203-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust Tight, Gasketed Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(LBS)
$924.00
1980-1203-R-SP-R-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1203-R-SP-R-TD1
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
03= 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switches
R = Rubber Boot on Switch Plunger
TD1 = Timing Dial Clock Wise Rotation
$1,141.00
1980-1203-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1203-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
03 = Qty. 3, Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
$960.00
1980-1203-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1203-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
03 = Qty. 3, Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
$924.00
1980-1204 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
4 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
= Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
= DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
$1,014.00
1980-1204-D-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-D-DP-X
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
4 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
$1,196.00
1980-1204-D-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-D-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
D = Dual (2) Shaft Extensions from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660 TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Warranty
$1,249.00
1980-1204-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure. Dust Tight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Double, 2 Shaft Extensions from the enclosure, @ each end
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,068.00
1980-1204-D-SPG-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model Like 1980-1204-D-SPG-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extensions from Enclosure, 2
SPG = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch, with Gold Plated Contacts
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boots on the Switch Plunger for additional protection from Moisture & Dust
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
(19LBS) 1/11 CF
Call
1980-1204-D-SPP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-D-SPP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Double Shaft Extension from enclosure. Right & Left Side
SPP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch with Plug in Sockets
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(18LBS)
$1,296.00
1980-1204-L-DP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-L-DP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure, Dust Tight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,323.00
1980-1204-L-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-L-DP-X
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
4 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
$1,142.00
1980-1204-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(19LBS)
$1,014.00
1980-1204-R-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-R-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust Tight / Gasketed
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,142.00
1980-1204-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure, Dust Tight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,195.00
1980-1204-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(19LBS)
$1,014.00
1980-1204-X-DP-X-S-80-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-DP-X-S-80-R
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
4 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches, Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
80 = 80 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
(24LBS)
$2,033.00
1980-1204-X-SP-R-72-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-R-72-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension opposite gear box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R = Right Angle Drive Gear Reducer
72 = 18 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Shaft Location
$1,062.00
1980-1204-X-SP-X-R-6-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-X-R-6-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
R = Right Angle Drive Gear Reducer
6 = 6 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Shaft Location, Right End, Shaft Position 1
$1,773.00
1980-1204-X-SP-X-R-8-R3 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-X-R-8-R3
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
R = Right Angle Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
R3 = Shaft Location
$1,773.00
1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-2.2-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-2.2-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
2.2 = 2.2 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$1,905.00
1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-25-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-25-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Gasketed / Dust Tight
04 = 4 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch, # 1950-1-B-A-AO
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$1,905.00
1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-4-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-4-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$1,905.00
1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-7-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-7-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
7 = 7 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$1,905.00
1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-8-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-8-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$1,905.00
1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-8-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SP-X-S-8-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$1,905.00
1980-1204-X-SPR-X-R10-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-SPR-X-R-10-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust Tight
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
R = Right Angle Drive Gear Reducer
10 = 10 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Shaft Location, Left End, Shaft Position 1
$1,821.00
1980-1205-D-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1205-D-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension from enclosure, 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for Clockwise Rotation, 0-360 Degrees
3 Year Limited Warranty
(22LBS)
$1,578.00
1980-1205-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1205-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure, 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,524.00
1980-1205-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1205-L-SP-X
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
5 = 5 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
$1,343.00
1980-1205-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1205-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure, 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,524.00
1980-1205-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1205-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure, 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
3 Year Limited Warranty
(22LBS)
$1,343.00
1980-1205-X-DP-S-6-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1205-X-DP-X-S-6-R
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
05 = 5 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches, Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
6 = 6 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,394.00
1980-1205-X-DP-X-R-14-R4 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1205-X-DP-X-R-14-R4
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, gasketed dust tight
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
14 = 14 to 1 Gear Ratio
R4 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 4
$2,262.00
1980-1206-D-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-D-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
6 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(16LBS)
$1,704.00
1980-1206-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual / Double Shaft, one out of each end of the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,512.00
1980-1206-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,458.00
1980-1206-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,639.00
1980-1206-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,458.00
1980-1206-X-DP-R-X-S-14-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-DP-R-X-S-14-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boots on the switch plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
14 = 14 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right Side, Gear Box & Main Shaft
$2,613.00
1980-1206-X-DP-X-R-18-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-DP-X-R18-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
R = Right Angle Drive Gear Reducer
18 = 18 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Shaft Location
$2,409.00
1980-1206-X-DP-X-S-1.33-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-DP-X-S-1.33-L
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches, Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
1.33 = 1.33 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$2,541.00
1980-1206-X-DP-X-S-1.33-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-DP-X-S-1.33-R
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches, Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
1.33 = 1.33 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,541.00
1980-1206-X-DP-X-S-80-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-DP-X-S-80-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer, Parallel with main shaft
80 = 80 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Gear Box & Main Shaft Right End
$2,541.00
1980-1206-X-DP-X-S36-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-DP-X-S-36-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 06 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
36 = 36 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$2,541.00
1980-1206-X-SP-R-X-S-16-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-R-X-S-16-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gear box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot on the switch plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
16 = 16 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer
(28LBS)
$2,421.00
1980-1206-X-SP-TD1-S-25-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-TD1-S-25-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD1 = Timing Dial labeled for clock wise rotation
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,530.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-R-10-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-X-R-10-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
6 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
10 = 10 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$2,217.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-R-5-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-X-R-5-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$2,217.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-R-6-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-X-R-6-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
6 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
6 = 6 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$2,217.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-15-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-S-15-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
15 = 15 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
(26LBS)
$2,349.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-24-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-24-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
24 = 24 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,349.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-25-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-25-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,349.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-30-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-30-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
30 = 30 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
(26LBS)
$2,349.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-35-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-S-35-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Gasketed, Dust Tight
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
35 = 35 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Box & Output Shaft Location
(26LBS)
$2,349.00
1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-8-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-X-SP-X-S-8-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,349.00
1980-1206-Y-SP-X-S-35-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1206-Y-SP-X-S-35-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Y = No shaft extension opposite gear box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
35 = 35 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
$2,403.00
1980-1207-D-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1207-D-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
D = Dual (2) Shaft Extensions from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Warranty
$1,810.00
1980-1207-L-DP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1207-L-DP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure, Gasketed / Dust Tight
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,980.00
1980-1207-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1207-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure, Gasketed / Dust Tight
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,756.00
1980-1207-R-DP-R-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1207-R-DP-R-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure, Gasketed / Dust Tight
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boots on the switch plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,064.00
1980-1207-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1207-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Warranty
$1,756.00
1980-1207-X-SP-TD1-S6L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1207-X-SP-TD1-S-6-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Gasketed Dust Tight
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear B-ox
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
6 = 6 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer
$2,647.00
1980-1208-D-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-D-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
D = Dual (2) Shaft Extensions from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial labeled for Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Warranty
$1,925.00
1980-1208-D-SP-TD3 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-D-SP-TD3
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
D = Dual (2) Shaft Extensions from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD3 = Timing Dial labeled for Clock Wise Rotation with the main shaft vertical
3 Year Warranty
(32LBS)
$1,925.00
1980-1208-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
D = Dual (2) Shaft Extensions from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No other options
3 Year Warranty
$1,744.00
1980-1208-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
08 = 8 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(26LBS)
$1,690.00
1980-1208-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(26LBS)
$1,690.00
1980-1208-X-SP-TD1-S-14-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-X-SP-TD1-S-14-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
08 = 08 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for Clockwise Rotation
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
14 = 14 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
(37LBS)
$2,762.00
1980-1208-X-SP-X-R-18-L7 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-X-SP-X-R-18-L7
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
18 = 18 to 1 Gear Ratio
L7 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 7
(28LBS)
$2,449.00
1980-1208-X-SP-X-R-25-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-X-SP-X-R-25-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R = Right Angle Drive Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Shaft Location
$2,449.00
1980-1208-X-SP-X-S-30-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-X-SP-X-S-30-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dustight
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
30 = 30 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
(28LBS)
$2,581.00
1980-1208-X-SP-X-S12-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1208-X-SP-X-S12-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust tight
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
12 = 12 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Box & Main Shaft Location
$2,581.00
1980-1209-L-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1209-L-SP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$2,300.00
1980-1209-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1209-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dustight
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,119.00
1980-1209-R-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1209-R-SP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty (12LBS)
$2,300.00
1980-1209-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1209-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dustight
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,119.00
1980-1209-X-SP-X-S40-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1209-X-SP-X-S-40-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust Tight with gasket
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
40 = 40 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$3,010.00
1980-1210-D-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1210-D-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust Tight
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extensions from Enclosure, 2
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,685.00
1980-1210-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1210-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boots on the Snap Switch Plunger for additional Dust & Moisture Protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,431.00
1980-1210-X-SP-R-X-R-7.5-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1210-X-SP-R-X-R-7.5-L1
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw Snap Switch U.L. Listed
R = Rubber Boot on Snap Switch Plunger
X = No Timing Dial
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
7.5 = 7.5 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Right End Shaft Location, Position 1
(34LBS)
$3,190.00
1980-1210-Y-DP-X-S1-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1210-X-DP-X-S1-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
Y = Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
1 = 1 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
$3,576.00
1980-1211-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1211-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
11 = 11 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
$2,686.00
1980-1211-L-SP-X-R-7-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1211-X-SP-X-R-7-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust Tight
11= 11 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
7 = 7 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$3,264.00
1980-1212-D-SP-TD3 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1212-D-SP-TD3
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
12 = 12 Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD3 = Timing Dial, Clock Wiser Rotation, Vertical Mounting
$2,903.00
1980-1212-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1212-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(21LBS)
$2,722.00
1980-1212-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1212-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty (32LBS)
$2,668.00
1980-1212-X-DP-X-R-5-R3 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1212-X-DP-X-R-5-R3
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Precision Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
R3 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 3
$3,811.00
1980-1212-X-DP-X-R-6-L7 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1212-X-DP-X-R-6-L7
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
6 = 6 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$3,811.00
1980-1212-X-SP-X-S5L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1212-Y-SP-X-S-5-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure, Gasketed / Dust Tight
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Main Shaft Opposite of the Gear Box. Single output shaft
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
5 = 5 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer
3 Year Limited Warranty
$3,559.00
1980-1215-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1215-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
15 = 15 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
$3,439.00
1980-1216-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1216-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
16 = 16 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(50LBS)
$3,578.00
1980-1346 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-104-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
Special Engineered Product, 3 Cams with a provision for a 4th cam installed by the OEM. A switch is installed but the OEM provided their own or left out the cam in the spare area for future use
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$855.00
1980-1535 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1535 like a 1980-102-L-SP-X with a special main shaft
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
Specially Engineered Main Shaft Extension: 1/2 Inch Dia X 2 & 5/8 Inches Long
Perkins Press
(10LBS)
$654.00
1980-1615 Gemco Cam Limit Switch
NEMA 1
4 Circuit
SPDT Switches
Right Angle Gear Reducer, 5 to 1 Ratio
Shaft Position R3
Special Output Shaft / Quad Thread
$1,499.00
1980-1669 Ametek Gemco Deck Type Limit Switch. 3 Decks. 1950-1-B-A-AO Call
1980-1780 Ametek Gemco 1980-104-L-SP-X & a 1970-104 Drive-Chek $773.00
1980-1804 Ametek Gemco Special Cam Limit Switch
1980 Series Cam Limit Switch
Resolver
Special Differential
$5,300.00
1980-1928 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Like Model 1980-104-L-SP-X
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
Special OEM Product provided to Midland Ross in 1975
Has a special 2 & 7/16 Inch Main Shaft Extension from the Cam Box with the Shaft End Tapped for a 1/4 - 20 fastener
(12LBS)
$662.00
1980-2090 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
Qty. 3, SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Qty. 1, DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch, circuit 4
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(18LBS) 8/8
$906.00
1980-2097 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-104-L-SP-X but with a SPECIAL CAM
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
One Specially Engineered Cam has been installed
Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660 9/9
$664.00
1980-2152 Ametek Gemco DUAL SHAFT Rotating Cam Limit Switch with Qty. 2, parallel shafts each having Qty. 3, circuits / cams / switches. Precision snap Acting D.P.D.T. Switches. Total 6 circuits. The 2 parallel shafts are coupled with a chain & sprocket inside the enclosure. A Gemco 3001-3 Adjustable Coupling is used to allow timing changes between the 2 shafts. Right hand shaft extension in position ''D'' with a second Gemco 3001-3 Adjustable Coupling. NEMA 4 Metal Enclosure. Originally designed for Kaiser Steel in 1977 $3,405.00
1980-2179 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Like a 1980-103-L-SP-X with 2 Special Cams
Cam #1 = SD0189100 (Min. Dwell) cir #1 location LH side
Cam #2 = SD0164600 (Min. Lobe) cir #2 location
Cam #3 = SD0117800 (Standard) cir #3 location
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$584.00
1980-2312 Ametek Gemco Specially Engineered Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring some of the cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure, Specially Engineered Enclosure & Cover
18 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
Qty 16, SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Qty 2, DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
13 Standard Cams, SD0117800
2 Special 15 Degree Cams, SD0203000
1 Special 75 Degree Cam, SD0203100
2 Special 40 Degree Cams, 1/2 Circuit, Right Hand, SD0207500
Internal Right Angle Gear Reducer with a having a 6:1 ratio
3 Position Selector Switch, 22mm with a Black Lever, Spring Return
9/6
$4,075.00
1980-2366 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch. 7 circuits / Cams / Switches. Single Pole Double Throw Switches. Dual Output Shafts. External Timing Dial with Pulse Disk and Switch. Includes # 3001-1 1/2 Inch Sprocket Drive Coupling. $2,248.00
1980-23875A Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch. Specially engineered product Call
1980-2411 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 12 --- Brake Monitor Enclosure
2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$845.00
1980-2441 Ametek Gemco Series 1980 Rotating Cam Limit Switch. 11 Circuit Cam Box with 5 Standard Cams and 6 Special Cut Cams with 20 Degree of Dwell. SPDT switches with Rubber Plunger Boots for addition dust & moisture protection. Includes a Right Angle Gear Reducer with a 10 to 1 Gear Ratio mounted on the Left End with the 1/2 Inch Shaft in Position L1 . NEMA 12 Enclosure $3,427.00
1980-2477 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model Engineered Part number & product. Enclosure to have a safety ''Lock Out'' on the enclosure
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Warranty 1/8
$1,724.00
1980-2527 Ametek Gemco 1980 Series Cam Box
OEM Link Systems, proprietary sales through Link only
NEMA 1 Enclosure
2 Independent Circuits / Cam / Switches
''Add a Cam'' feature which allows enclosure space for the OEM or End User to add 2 cams at a later date
Right Hand Shaft Extension
Tach Generator Module
Precision Snap Acting Single Pole Double Trow Switches S.P.D.T.
Roller Followers were included
Call
1980-2529 Ametek Gemco / Link Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-2529
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
With Encoder, Brevel Motors, 902436
Link Electric only
Call
1980-2529T Ametek Gemco / Link Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-2529
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
With Encoder, Brevel Motors, 902436
Link Electric only Was 1980-2529 Now includes a Tach Generator
Call
1980-2643 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
No Timing Dial
Straight Drive Gear Reducer with Differential
48 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location 1/11
$7,110.00
1980-2724T Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch with a Tach Generator Mounted on the Right Side & a 1970-104 Drive-Chek
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
10/10
$1,247.00
1980-2761 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Like Switch Model 1980-911-X-SP-TD1-S-12-L
Series 1980
9 = NEMA 9 Group F Enclosure
11 = 11 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft opposite gearbox
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switches U.L. Listed
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
S = Straight Drive Gear Box
12 = 12 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Gear Box Mounted to Left End
With Strip Heater & Thermostat
(50LBS)
$5,045.00
1980-3004B Ametek Gemco Cam Limit Switch
4 Circuit with SPDT Switches
NEMA 1 with Custom Enclosure & Main Shaft Detail
Left Hand Shaft Extension
With the ''ADD A CAM'' feature for future or OEM addition of Cam / Circuit
$979.38
1980-3010T Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-3010T, replaced 1980-3010
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
Qty 3, SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Qty 1, DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Add on Tach Gen Module PSD153603 Includes Drive Chek 1970-104 & 2 Special Cams SD2231 110 Degrees & Cam SD2382 45 Degrees on the DPDT Switch 4 weeks 6/7
$1,275.00
1980-3087 Ametek Gemco 1980 Series Cam Box with Motion Detect.
NEMA 1 Enclosure
5 Circuit / Switch / Cam
with Motion Detect
$1,130.00
1980-3145 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell & the ''Add & Cam Feature'' A cam and switch can be added, for a 4th circuit, without removal of the main shaft
NEMA 1 Enclosure
3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches Add a Cam Feature allows an OEM to easily add a cam will their timing & dwell without removal of the main shaft.
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
3 Year Limited Warranty (12LBS) 10/10
$762.00
1980-3146 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
5 Cams / Circuits / Switches, with the ''Add a Cam'' feature for a future or OEM circuit. The ''Add a Cam'' feature makes it easy to add a 6th Circuit without removing the Main Shaft from the Frame.
Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(14LBS) 1/11
$1,100.00
1980-3151 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Specially Engineered Left Hand Shaft which extends 2.5 Inches for the enclosure with a 1/4-20 Tapped Hole in the end and a 3/16 Wide x 3/32 Deep Keyway starting 1 inch from the shaft end
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS) 1/10
$749.00
1980-3157 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-3157
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
SD0197700 Optical Disc
SD0194800 Motion Detect Switch in Circuit 6
(29LBS) 7/6
$987.00
1980-3315 Gemco 1980 Series Cam Box
Specially engineered product
4 Circuit
NEMA 4X, 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure
1 to 3 Straight Drive Gear Multiplier, Internally Mounted
SPDT Switches with the Rubber Boot option
Enclosure is heated with a Thermostat Controlled Strip Heater
Double Shaft Extensions from enclosure
2001403 8/7
$2,915.00
1980-3327 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model Like model 1980-1210-X-SP-X-R-10-R1
Series 1980
NEMA 12 Enclosure
10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw Snap Switch U.L. Listed
No Timing Dial is to be included
Right Angle Gear Reducer
10 to 1 Gear Ratio
Right End Shaft Location, Position 1
Special 6 Inch Diameter Cams normally used with the Series 1997 Gate Hoist Products Line
A larger enclosure is also required to enclose these larger cams
(45LBS) 11/8
$3,752.00
1980-3383 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-3383
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
10 = 10 Cams / Circuits / Switches
2 of these cams do not have adjustable dwell. They are machined with 25 degrees of dwell
Right Hand Shaft extension from enclosure
9 Single Pole Double Throw Switches
1 1950-1406 Slow Make - Slow Break Switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
$3,750.00
1980-3426 Ametek Gemco 1980 Series Cam Limit Switch
Engineered Part Number
6 Circuit / Cams
NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure, Watertight
SPDT UL Rated Snap Switches
Right Hand Unit
Gear Multiplier, 4 to 1 Ratio
Includes an Ametek Gemco 1/2 Inch Direct Drive Coupling. Maximum torque rating 300 lb.-in. 1/2 inch direct & sprocket drive 404 woodruff keyway & key. 50 turns of the adjusting screw will rotate coupling 360 degrees. For easily made incremental adjustment between drive shaft & cam box
$2,486.00
1980-3434 Ametek Gemco 1980 Series Cam Box
NEMA 12 Enclosure
6 Circuits / Cams / Switches
Double Ended Shaft Extension
Pulse Generating Disc
Built in 1983 for International Harvester
$1,571.00
1980-3461 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
R4 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 4
With Linear Potentiometer, 1 to 1 Ratio, Internally Mounted, 1500 OHM, Single Turn, 2 Watt, Wire Wound
Call
1980-3486 Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Add On Feature / Enclosure Space provided for a Tach Generator on the Right Hand End
Tach Generator is to be supplied buy others
Lock Out Attachment for padlocking the cover closed, padlock is not included
(19LBS) 11/9
$1,343.00
1980-3503 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-3503
Series 1980
NEMA 9 Enclosure with strip heater & thermostat
11 Cams / Circuits / Switches
Timing Dial is included
Straight Drive Gear Reducer 10 to 1 Ratio
4 to 6 weeks to ship.
$5,592.00
1980-3510 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-3510 Similar to 1980-1204-L-SP-X
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
Specially machined cams 2 @ 15 Degrees Dwell & 2 @ 60 Degrees Dwell
Special 1950-1413 Switches. SPDT Slow Make - Slow Break, can be wired for Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals. The 1950-1413 previously supplied switch is no longer available. It was a SPST switch with a normally closed contact only
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided 5/6
$1,309.00
1980-3513 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
Qty. 4, SPDT Switches located in positions 1,2,6 & 6,Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Qty. 2, DPDT Switches located in positions 3 & 4, Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Right Angle Gear Reducer
10 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Position / Location 1
$1,704.00
1980-3521X NEMA 1
7 Circuit
Left Hand
7 Circuit
6 SP
1 DP
Call
1980-3695 Engineered Product Call
1980-3742 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit
Series 1980
NEMA 9 Enclosure
11 Cams / Circuits / Switches
Double Pole Double Throw Switches
Straight Drive Gear Reducer
12 to 1 Gear Ratio
With Timing Dial, Strip Heater & Thermostat
$5,637.00
1980-3786T Ametek Gemco Limit Switch. Proprietary sold through Link Electric & Safety Control Co only with SPDT Switches & RF Call
1980-3809 Ametek Gemco Cam Limit Switch
Engineered Part Number
Like 1980-409-R-SP-X with Tach Gen., Spring Return & Clutch
Call
1980-3818 Like 1980-104-R-SP-S with Link Tack Gen Module & Tach with Internal Resolver Call
1980-3843 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4 Stainless Steel Enclosure with Strip Heater & Thermostat
5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Rubber Boots on the Switch Plungers for additional moisture & dust protection
Straight Drive Gear Reducer
40 to 1 Gear Ratio
Right End Shaft Location
$2,750.00
1980-3853 Ametek Gemco Rotary Cam Limit Switch
NEMA 1 Enclosure, 7 to 8 Circuit Size Drawing D0097100 with Add on Tach
6 Circuit / Cam / Switch
Tach Generator & Resolver Driven by a common Belt 04575082, 126 Pin
Right Hand Shaft Extension
6/9
$3,192.00
1980-3875A Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch. Specially engineered product Call
1980-3915 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-406-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, cover, latches, bearing flanges & flange bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,683.00
1980-3924 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Enclosure
6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Internal Right Angle Gear Reducer on the Right Side
6 to 1 Gear Ratio 11/10
$1,530.00
1980-3944T Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch with Internal Resolver 04535001 & Tach Generator 04573067
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided 1/11
$1,929.00
1980-3948 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4 Enclosure, Water Tight
10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Right Hand Shaft Extension
Qty. 7, SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Qty. 3, DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw , Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch. Positions 8,9 & 10
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty 1/11
$2,500.00
1980-3953 Ametek Gemco Rotary Cam Limit Switch
NEMA 1 Enclosure
8 Circuit / Cam / Switch
SPDT Switches
Left Hand Shaft Extension
Specially Engineered Shaft Extension
Call
1980-3963 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4X Enclosure, Watertight. 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges & Flange Bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Warranty
(20LBS) 5/9
$1,467.00
1980-3975 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-3975
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Enclosure
12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure Left Hand Shaft Extension has an External Timing Dial Mounted on it
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,184.00
1980-3989 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
Engineered product with both Single & Double Throw Switches
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
40 = 40 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Position 1
$2,033.00
1980-3990 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
Engineered product with both Single & Double Throw Switches, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
20= 20 to 1 Gear Ratio
L1 = Left End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,771.00
1980-4003 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 1 Enclosure
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Double, 2 Shaft Extensions from the enclosure. RH is 3/4 Inches in Diameter & LH is 1/2 Inch in Diameter, waiting on the additional shaft specifications from engineering @ Ametek. I expect about $ 1200.00
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
3 Year Limited Warranty
(13LBS)
Call
1980-401-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-401-R-SP-X
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Water Resistant Enclosure
01 = 1 Cams / Circuit / Switch
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switch U.L. Listed
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Warranty
(19LBS)
$898.00
1980-402-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-402-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension from enclosure, 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(18LBS)
$1,012.00
1980-402-R-DP-X 1980-402-R-DP-X $1,022.00
1980-402-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-402-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,139.00
1980-402-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-402-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(18LBS)
$958.00
1980-402-X-DP-X-R-10-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-402-X-DP-X-R-10-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches. The micro-adjust cams maintain accuracy / repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand. The cams have a switch setting range of 4 through 356 Degrees
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch.Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
10 = 10 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,781.00
1980-402-X-SP-X-R-40-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-402-X-SP-X-R-40-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
2 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
40 = 40 to 1 Gear Ratio
R1 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 1
$1,717.00
1980-403-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-403-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(20BS)
$1,254.00
1980-403-X-DP-X-S-200-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-403-X-DP-X-S-200-L
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
3 = 3 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No shaft extension opposite gear box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
26 LBS Gross
$2,060.00
1980-403-X-SP-X-S200-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-403-X-SP-X-S-200-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure / Watertight
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gear box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
26 LBS
$1,964.00
1980-404 X-SP-R-X-S-60-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-R-X-S-60-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = R = Rubber boot on Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer. Shaft parallel to main shaft
60 = 60 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer Location
(26LBS)
$2,130.00
1980-404-D-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-D-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell04 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double / 2 Shaft Extensions from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boot on Switch Plunger for addition moisture & contaminant protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(19LBS)
$1,293.00
1980-404-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension, Shaft Extension from both ends of the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Warranty
(20LBS)
$1,245.00
1980-404-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Warranty
(18LBS)
$1,191.00
1980-404-R-DP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-R-DP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for Clockwise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$1,500.00
1980-404-R-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-R-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
4 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
3 Year Warranty
(18LBS)
$1,319.00
1980-404-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell04 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
4 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boot on Switch Plunger for addition moisture & contaminant protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
(21LBS)
$1,239.00
1980-404-R-SP-TW2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-R-SP-TW2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TW2 = Timing Dial & Timing Dial Window, Labeled for CCW Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,418.00
1980-404-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(20LBS)
$1,191.00
1980-404-X-DP-X-S-200-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-DP-X-S-200-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
(24LBS)
$2,210.00
1980-404-X-DP-X-S-40-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-DP-X-S-40-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
40 = 40 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
(24LBS)
$2,210.00
1980-404-X-DP-X-S-400-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-DP-X-S-400-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
400 = 400 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
(24LBS)
$2,210.00
1980-404-X-DPR-X-R1-R3 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-DP-R-X-R-1-R3
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Seal / Boot on the Snap Switch Plunger for additional Dust & Moinsture Protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
1 = 1 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer at Shaft Position 3
(24LBS)
$2,126.00
1980-404-X-SP-R-X-S-28L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-R-X-S-28-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boots on the Snap Switch Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
28 = 28 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer
(24LBS)
$2,130.00
1980-404-X-SP-R-X-S-400-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-R-X-S-400-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional Moisture & Dust Protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer. Shaft parallel to main shaft
400 = 400 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer Location
(26LBS)
$2,130.00
1980-404-X-SP-R-X-S-60-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-R-X-S-60-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
60 = 60 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
(24LBS)
$2,130.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-R-15-R2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-R-15-R2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
15 = 15 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
2 = Shaft Location Position 2
$1,950.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-R-60-R2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-R-60-R2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
60 = 60 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
2 = Shaft Location Position 2
$1,950.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-R-80-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-R-80-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
80 = 80 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Right End Shaft Location
1 = Shaft Location Position 1
$1,950.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-R30-R4 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-R-30-R4
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
30 = 30 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
4 = Shaft Location Position 4
$1,950.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-S-100-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-100-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
100 = 100 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
(29LBS)
$2,082.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-S-169-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-169-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
169 = 169 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,082.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-S-200-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-200-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch, 1950-1-B-A-AO
X = No Timing Dial or timing dial window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,082.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-S-200-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-200-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,082.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-S-30-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-30-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
30 = 30 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,082.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-S-35-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-35-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
35 = 35 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,082.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-S-48-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-48-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
48 = 48 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$2,082.00
1980-404-X-SP-X-S-50-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-50-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
50 = 50 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,082.00
1980-404-X-SPR-X-S28-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SPR-X-S28-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Seal / Boot on the Snap Switch Plunger for addition dust & moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
28 = 28 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Gear Reducer mounted on the Right End
$2,130.00
1980-404-X-SSP-X-S-35-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-404-X-SSP-X-S-35-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SSP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 Screw Terminals per Switch with a Plug-In Socket
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
35 = 35 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Box & Output Shaft Location
$2,310.00
1980-404-Y-DP-X-R-4-R3 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch 1980-404-Y-DP-X-R-4-R3
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Y = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
R3 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 3
$2,132.00
1980-405-D-DP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-D-DP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure, Watertight
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Double Shaft Extension from Enclosure, shaft out both ends
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,792.00
1980-405-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-D-SP-X
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
5 = 5 Cams / Circuits / Switches
D = Double Shaft Extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
$1,572.00
1980-405-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure, Watertight
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(22LBS)
$1,578.00
1980-405-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,518.00
1980-405-R-SPP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-R-SPP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw with the Optional Plug-In Socket. Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot option on Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(22LBS)
$1,863.00
1980-405-X-DP-X-S-200-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-X-DP-X-S-200-L
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
5 = 5 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No shaft extension opposite gear box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
(30LBS)
$2,569.00
1980-405-X-SP-TD1-S-200-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-X-SP-TD1-S-200-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
05 = 5 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD1 = Timing Dial labeled for clockwise rotation
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
$2,590.00
1980-405-X-SP-X-S-12L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-X-SP-X-S-12-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
12 = 12 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End, Gear Reducer & Shaft Location
(30LBS)
$2,409.00
1980-405-X-SP-X-S80-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-X-SP-X-S-80-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
80 = 80 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,409.00
1980-405-Y-SP-X-M-6-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-405-Y-SP-X-M-6-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Watertight Enclosure
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Y = No shaft extension oposite the gear multiplier
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
M = Gear Multiplier supplied
6 = 6 to 1 Ratio on the gear multiplier
R = Right End, Gear Multiplier located on the Right Side
3 Year Limited Warranty
(30LBS)
$2,463.00
1980-406-D-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-D-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extension , 2 from Enclosure, each end
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$1,761.00
1980-406-D-SP-R-X-S-80-L Ametek Gemco Cam Limit Switch 1980-406-D-SP-R-X-S-80-L $2,652.00
1980-406-D-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-D-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure, Watertight
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shafts Extending from Enclosure,Two
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(36LBS)
$1,870.00
1980-406-L-SP-R-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-L-SP-RTD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot on switch plunger for moisture & dust protection
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(36LBS)
$1,888.00
1980-406-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(27LBS)
$1,816.00
1980-406-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,635.00
1980-406-L-SP-X-S200-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-L-SP-X-S200-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure / Water Tight
06 = 6 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left End Shaft Extensions from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$2,526.00
1980-406-R-3DP/3SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-R-3DP/3SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
3DP = Qty 3 DP Switches
3SP = Qty 3 SP Switches
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,008.00
1980-406-R-DP-X-R-30-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-DP-X-R-30-R-1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
R = Right Angle Drive Gear Reducer
30 = to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer / Shaft Location 1
$2,586.00
1980-406-R-DP-X-S-2-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-DP-X-S-2-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
2 = 2 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer / Shaft Location
$2,718.00
1980-406-R-SP-R-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-R-SP-R-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot on switch plunger for moisture & dust protection
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(36LBS)
$1,888.00
1980-406-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot option on switch plunger for additional protection from moisture & dust
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,707.00
1980-406-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(27LBS)
$1,816.00
1980-406-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,635.00
1980-406-R-SPP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-R-SPP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
P = Plug In Switch Socket
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot option on switch plunger for additional protection from moisture & dust
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(25LBS)
$2,049.00
1980-406-X-DP-X-M-3-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-DP-X-M-3-R
Series 1980 Vertex S827-6800-30
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches, Double Pole Double Throw Snap Action Switches U.L. Listed
X = No Timing Dial
M= Multiplier Drive
3 = 1 to 3 Multiplier Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
1980-4478
$2,718.00
1980-406-X-DP-X-S-2-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-R-DP-X-S-2-L
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
6 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
DP = D.P.D.T. Switches, Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Acting
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight drive Gear Reducer
2 = 2 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$2,718.00
1980-406-X-SP-R-X-S-20-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-R-X-S-20-R
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches
R = Rubber Boot Option
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Gear Reducer
20 = 20 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right Shaft Location
$2,598.00
1980-406-X-SP-R-X-S-25-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-R-X-S-25-R
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches
R = Rubber Boot Option
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right Shaft Location
$2,598.00
1980-406-X-SP-TD4-R-15-L8 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-TD4-R-15-L8
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
6 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
TD4 = Timing Dial 0 - 360 Vertical Labeling for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
15 = 15 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
8 = Shaft Location Position 8
3 Year Warranty
$2,575.00
1980-406-X-SP-X-R-100-R6 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-X-R-100-R6
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Watertight Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
100 = 100 to 1 Gear Ratio
R6 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 6
$2,394.00
1980-406-X-SP-X-R-15-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-X-R-15-R1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
15 = 15 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
1 = Shaft Location Position 1
$2,394.00
1980-406-X-SP-X-R-25-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-X-R-25-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box, no ''L'' available in this spot?
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
1 = Shaft Location Position 1
$2,394.00
1980-406-X-SP-X-R-96-L-4 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-X-R-96-L4
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
96 = 96 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
1 = Shaft Location Position 4
(34LBS)
$2,394.00
1980-406-X-SP-X-S-14-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-X-S-14-R
Series 1980 30 LBS Gross
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
14 = 14 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,526.00
1980-406-X-SP-X-S-15-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-SP-X-S-15-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
15 = 15 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
(34LBS)
$2,526.00
1980-406-Y-SP-TD1-S-15-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-Y-SP-TD1-S-15-L
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
6 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
Y = Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial 0 - 360 Clock Wise
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
15 = 15 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
3 Year Warranty
(35LBS)
$2,761.00
1980-406-Y-SP-X-S-8-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-Y-SP-X-S-8-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
Y = Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box / Double Shaft Extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,580.00
1980-407-R-DP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-407-R-DP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty (29LBS)
$2,156.00
1980-407-R-DP-TD3 Ametek Gemco 1980-407-R-DP-TD3 $2,156.00
1980-407-R-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-407-R-SP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty (27LBS)
$1,932.00
1980-407-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-407-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(27LBS)
$1,751.00
1980-407-X-SP-R-X-S- Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-407-X-SP-R-S-100-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot option on Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
100 = 100 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer / Main Shaft
$2,726.00
1980-407-X-SP-R-X-S-25-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-407-X-SP-R-X-S-25-R
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
7 = 7 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches
R = Rubber Boot Option
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Gear Reducer
25 = 25 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right Shaft Location
$2,726.00
1980-407-X-SP-R-X-S-32R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-407-X-SP-R-S-32-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot option on Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Reverse Rotation
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
32 = 32 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer / Main Shaft
$2,726.00
1980-407-X-SP-X-S-1.25-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-407-X-SP-X-S-1.25-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
1.25 = 1.25 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
$2,642.00
1980-407-X-SPP-R-TD1-S10-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-407-X-SPP-TD1-S-10-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SPP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch with Plug in Sockets
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labled / Numbered for Clock Wise Rotation
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
10 = 10 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Gear Reducer
$3,222.00
1980-4077 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch. Engineered Product 6/9 $1,910.00
1980-408-L-DP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-L-DP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(LBS)
$2,217.00
1980-408-L-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-L-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boot option on switch plunger
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(32LBS)
$1,961.00
1980-408-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = Manufactured to NEMA 4 Specifications, Watertight
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(32LBS)
$2,046.00
1980-408-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(32LBS)
$1,865.00
1980-408-R-DP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-R-DP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals per switch
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Warranty
(32LBS)
$2,302.00
1980-408-R-DP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-R-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty (32LBS)
$2,121.00
1980-408-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot on the switch plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
$1,961.00
1980-408-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Warranty
(32LBS)
$1,865.00
1980-408-X-DP-R-TD3-R7.5-R2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-X-DP-R-TD3-R-7.5-R2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
8 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boots on the Switch Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
TD3 = Timing Dial Labeled for Clock Wise Rotation Vertical Mount
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
7.5 = 7.5 1 Gear Ratio
R2 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 2
$3,157.00
1980-408-X-DP-TD1-R-1-L1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-X-DP-TD1-R-1-L1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals per switch
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
L1 = Shaft Location from Gear Box
$3,061.00
1980-408-X-DP-X-S-8-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-X-DP-X-S-8-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer (36LBS)
$2,924.00
1980-408-X-SP-TD1-X-M-3-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-X-SP-TD1-M-3-R
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial Clock Wise Rotation
M= Multiplier Drive
3 = 1 to 3 Multiplier Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$2,937.00
1980-408-X-SP-X-R-50-R3 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-X-SP-X-R-50-R3
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox / no double shaft extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
R= Right Angle Gear Reducer
50 = 50 to 1 Gear Ratio
R3 = Right End Gear Reducer Shaft Location 3
$2,624.00
1980-408-X-SP-X-S120-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-X-SP-X-S-120-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
120 = 120 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft / Gearbox Location
$2,756.00
1980-408-X-SP-X-S4-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-X-SP-X-S-4-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft / Gearbox Location
$2,756.00
1980-408-Y-SP-X-M-4-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-408-Y-SP-X-M-4-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
08 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
Y = Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
M= Multiplier Drive
4 = 1 to 4 Multiplier Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
(36LBS)
$2,810.00
1980-409-R-4DP/5SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-409-R-4DP/5SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
09 = 9 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
4DP = Qty 4 DP Switches
5SP = Qty 5 SP Switches
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,620.00
1980-410-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-410-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Double Shaft Extension from both sides Enclosure 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,530.00
1980-410-L-SP-R-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-410-L-SP-R-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Watertight Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot on switch plunger for moisture & dust protection
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,777.00
1980-410-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-410-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,596.00
1980-410-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-410-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,476.00
1980-410-X-SP-TD1-M3-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-410-X-SP-TD1-M3-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
010 = 10 Independent Circuits / Cams / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X =
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for Clockwise Rotation M3 R
3 Year Limited Warranty
(14LBS)
$3,548.00
1980-410-X-SP-TD1-S-80-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-410-X-SP-TD1-S-80-R
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
10 = 10 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial, Clockwise Rotation
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
80 = 80 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$3,548.00
1980-410-X-SP-TD2-S-35-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-410-X-SP-TD2-S-35-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
35= 35 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
(24LBS)
$3,548.00
1980-410-X-SP-X-S-100-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-410-X-SP-X-S-100-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
10 = 10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660 X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
100 = 100 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$3,367.00
1980-411-R-SP-TD2 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-411-R-SP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
11= 11 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.C.W. Counter Clock Wise Rotation but without timing dial window on the enclosure
3 Year Warranty
(36LBS)
$2,849.00
1980-411-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-411-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
11 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,668.00
1980-411-X-SP-X-M-4-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-411-X-SP-X-M-4-R
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
11= 11 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
M = Multiplier Drive
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Multiplier
R = Right End Shaft Location
(43LBS)
$3,559.00
1980-411-X-SP-X-S-4-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-411-X-SP-X-S-4-R
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
11= 11 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$3,559.00
1980-412-D-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extensions from the Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,889.00
1980-412-D-SP-X-S200-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-D-SP-X-S200-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure / Water Tight
12 = 12 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extensions from Enclosure, 2
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
$3,780.00
1980-412-R-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-R-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$3,016.00
1980-412-R-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
12 = 12 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No other options
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,835.00
1980-412-X-SP-X-S-100-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-X-SP-X-S-100-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
12= 12 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
100 = 100 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
41 LBS
$3,726.00
1980-412-X-SP-X-S-36-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-X-SP-X-S-36-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
36 = 36 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$3,726.00
1980-412-X-SP-X-S-48-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-X-SP-X-S-48-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
48 = 48 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$3,726.00
1980-412-X-SP-X-S10-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-X-SP-X-S-10-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure, Watertight
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
10 = 10 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$3,726.00
1980-412-Y-SP-X-M-6-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-Y-SP-X-M-6-R
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
12 = 12 Cams / Circuits / Switches
Y = Shaft Extension oposite gearbox. (double)
SP = SPDT Switches. Single Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
M = Mutiplier Drive
6 = 1 to 6 Gear Multiplier Ratio
R = Gear Multiplier, Right End Loc
$3,780.00
1980-412-Y-SP-X-S-200-L Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-412-Y-SP-X-S-200-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
12 = 12 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
Y = Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box / Double Shaft Extension
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
200 = 200 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Box & Shaft Location
$3,780.00
1980-4125T Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-4125T
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
A Tach Generator has been mounted inside the enclosure along with a Resolver with outputs Compatible with all Gemco Electronic Modules 04535001
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS) 1/9
Call
1980-414-L-SP-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-414-L-SP-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
14 = 14 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
$3,461.00
1980-414-R-SP-R-TD1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 980-414-R-SP-R-TD1
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
14 = 14 Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
R = Rubber Boot on Switch Plunger
TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension
$3,629.00
1980-415-X-SP-TD1-S-12-R Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-415-X-SP-TD1-S-12-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
15 = 15 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer, shaft parallel with main shaft
12 = 12 to 1 Gear Ratio, every 12 turns of the main shaft the cams turn once
R = Right End Shaft Location
$4,468.00
1980-416-L-SP-TD1-R-100-R1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-416-L-SP-TD1-R-100-R1
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
16 = 16 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation
R = Right Angle Gear Reducer
100 = 100 to 1 Gear Reducer Ratio
R-1 = Shaft Location on Gear Reducer
$4,451.00
1980-416-L-SP-TW1 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-416-L-SP-TW1
Series 1980
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
16 = 16 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TW1 = Timing Dial C.W. Clock Wise Rotation with a Timing Dial Window on the Enclosure
$3,738.00
1980-416-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Cam Limit Switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees without a Tool - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Series 1980 Micro-Adjust Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Model 1980-416-R-SP-X
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
16 = Qty. 16, Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw with one NO and one NC contact per switch rated at 15 million cycles
X = No Timing Dial or dial window is to be provided
Warranty 3 years
With NEMA 4X Stainless Adder & 2.5 Inch Shaft Extension without woodruff key and keyslot
10% expedite fee for shipment within 2.5 week. Expedite fee will be dropped if factory does not ship in 2.5 weeks
$3,511.00
1980-416-R-SP-R-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-416-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
16 = 16 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$3,703.00
1980-4160 Ametek Gemco Cam Box like 1980R-406-X-DP-X-R-3-L with 304 Stainless Steel Option. NEMA 4X, 6 Circuits, 3 to 1 Ratio, Includes Resolver EC70289 # SD0308910. Enclosure size is to be the same as original units. Bascular Span Drawbridge Long Island NY. 1980-4160 RAGR/SS EN $4,260.00
1980-4161 Ametek Gemco Cam Box like1980R-406-X-DP-X-R-3-R with 304 Stainless Steel Option. NEMA 4X, 6 Circuits, 3 to 1 Ratio, Includes Resolver EC70289 # SD0308910. Enclosure size is to be the same as original units. Bascular Span Drawbridge Long Island NY. 1980-4161 RAGR/SS EN $4,260.00
1980-418X-L-SP-X Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-418X-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4X = NEMA 4X Enclosure, Watertight,
18 = 18 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
Call
1980-4223 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Specially Engineered Product
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4 Enclosure / Water Tight. Enclosure size same as 10 circuit unit
8 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation / TD2
Multiplier Gear Drive with a Ratio of 1 to 4
Encoder Provision, for a customer supplied encoder
(40LBS) 1/11
$3,354.00
1980-4245 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing,Dwell & a Resolver
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
(19LBS) 11/7
$1,451.00
1980-4254 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Reducer
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
Straight Drive Gear Reducer with a 35 to 1 Gear Ratio which is located on the Left Side
Provisions provided in the enclosure for mounting an encoder which is to be supplied by others
$3,830.00
1980-4290 Ametek Gemco
NEMA 4X Stainless Steel Enclosure
Internal 200 to 1 Ratio RA Gearbox
3 Circuit
Right Hand
SPDT Switches 1/11
$6,504.00
1980-4310 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like 1980-402-R-DP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4X Rated 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure
02 = 2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Timing Dial Window is to be provided 1/7
$1,157.00
1980-4323 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4X Stainless Steel Enclosure, Watertight - Weatherproof, Stainless Steel Enclosure includes the Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges, & Flange Bolts from 304 Stainless Steel. The 3/4 Inch Diameter Main / Input Shaft is 316 Stainless
06 = 6 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Double, 2 Shaft Extensions from the enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,040.00
1980-4325 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-406-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, cover, latches, bearing flanges & flange bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(24LBS)
$1,683.00
1980-4341 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell & a Resolver
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
3 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Straight Drive Gear Reducer
48 to 1 Gear Ratio
$4,500.00
1980-4375 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch with Resolver Model 1980R-103-X-SP- - 64-L5
Series 1980R with AMCI Style Resolver
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
03 = 3 Cams / Circuits / Switches
SP = Single Pole Double Throw Switches
64 = 64 to 1 Gear Reducer
L5 = Input Shaft Location
$1,586.00
1980-4376 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch1980-12-06-L-SP
Series 1980
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
06 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
SP = Single Pole Double Throw Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension
With Pulse Generating Disc & Switch in Circuit # 8
$1,531.00
1980-4380 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-4380 NEMA 12 Enclosure, 6 Circuit / Cam, Right Hand Shaft Extension, SPDT Switches, with AMCI Resolver SD0495600 $1,723.00
1980-4382 Ametek Gemco 1980 Series Rotating Cam Limit Switch. Similar to part # 1980-407-R-DP-X EXCEPT with a 316 Stainless Steel Shaft cam / main shaft along with a stainless steel drain / breather for the enclosure. NEMA 4 Enclosure, 7 Circuits / Cams, D.P.D.T. Snap Action Switches for all circuits, Right End Shaft Extension. $1,970.00
1980-4386 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch with Resolver Model 1980-4386
Series 1980R, Standard Resolver Output Compatible with all Gemco Electronic Modules. Resolver # 04535001
4 = NEMA 4X Rated Stainless Steel Enclosure, 304 Stainless Steel enclosure option that includes:
316 SS Camshaft, 304 SS Enclosure, Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges and Flange Bolts
8 = 8 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Timing Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Extension from Gear Reducer
35 = 35 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right, Gear Reducer is on the Right Side of the cam box
(44LBS)
$3,140.00
1980-4387 01-14-1383 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4X Stainless Steel Enclosure includes the Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges, & Flange Bolts from 304 Stainless Steel. The 3/4 Inch Diameter Main / Input Shaft is 316 Stainless. This construction meets a NEMA 4X Rating
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Rubber Boot on the Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty 1/11
$1,781.00
1980-4388 04-14-1384 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4X Stainless Steel Enclosure includes the Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges, & Flange Bolts from 304 Stainless Steel. The 3/4 Inch Diameter Main / Input Shaft is 316 Stainless. This construction meets a NEMA 4X Rating
4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boot on the Plunger for additional dust & moisture protection
Timing Dial labeled for Clockwise Rotation
The enclosure size is a 5 - 6 circuit size due to the TD1 timing dial option
3 Year Limited Warranty 1/11
$1,781.00
1980-4390 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Like Model 1980-407-R-SP-TD2
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Stainless Steel Enclosure
07 = 7 Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
Special: 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure & 316 Stainless Steel Shaft
The enclosure size is a 7 - 8 circuit size
$1,981.00
1980-4391 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-1204-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided Qty. 2, Single Turn Resolvers are mounted inside the enclosure SD0308900
3 Year Limited Warranty
$2,000.00
1980-4397 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4 Enclosure, Watertight
20 Independent Circuits / Switches / Cams
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
A Second Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw with a Heavy Duty Spring for High Vibration Applications. Can be wired for normally open or closed circuits, 4 screw terminals. Switch 1950-1414
Straight Drive Gear Reducer with a 14 to 1 Gear Ratio
Right End Gear Box Location 1/11
$5,253.00
1980-4400 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell & an Internally Mounted Tach Generator
NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Dual Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(16LBS)
$1,105.00
1980-4430 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch. Like Model 1980-404-X-SP-X-S-28-R
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure with the 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure option that includes:
316 SS Camshaft, 304 SS Enclosure, Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges and Flange Bolts
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
28 = 28 to 1 Gear Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
Morris Material Handling Originally
$2,664.95
1980-4436 Ametek Gemco Call
1980-4447 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-4447
NEMA 4
7 Circuit / Cam / Switch
Double Pole Double Throw Switches
With Resolver
With Stainless Steel Drain / Breather
$2,470.00
1980-4451 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model Like 1980-1204-D-SPG-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Dual Shaft Extensions from Enclosure, 2
SPG = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch, with Gold Plated Contacts
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boots on the Switch Plunger for additional protection from Moisture & Dust
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
(19LBS) 1/8
$992.00
1980-4452 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-1204-X-DP-X-S-4-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure, Dust Tight
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches, 1950-1414 Single Pole Double Throw with a Heavy Duty Spring for high vibration applications. Can be wired for normally open or closed circuits, 4 screw terminals
X = No Timing Dial
S= Straight Drive Gear Reducer
4 = 4 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer
$1,789.00
1980-4455 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-L-SP-TD2
Series 1980
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
8 = 8 Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw
TD2 = Timing Dial C.C.W. Counter Clock Wise Rotation
With 1 Special 30 Degree Cam Circuit.
$1,298.00
1980-4469 Ametek Gemco Engineered Product.Similar to part number 1980-408-X-DP-TDI-R-1-L1 except with provisions to mount and couple a customer supplied Dynapar Encoder. Series A5840960010
304 stainless steel enclosure, cover, latches, internal camshaft, bearing flanges & flange bolts
Gear Reducer is NEMA 4, (stainless is not available)
$3,716.00
1980-4478 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-406-X-DP-X-M-3-R
Series 1980 Vertex S827-6800-30
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
6 = 6 Cams / Circuits / Switches
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
DP = DPDT Switches, Double Pole Double Throw
X = No Timing Dial
M= Multiplier Drive
3 = 1 to 3 Multiplier Ratio
R = Right End Shaft Location
1980-4478
Call
1980-4484 Ametek Gemco Cam Limit Switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees without a Tool - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Series 1980 Micro-Adjust Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Model 1980-416-R-SP-X
4 = NEMA 4 Enclosure
16 = Qty. 16, Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw with one NO and one NC contact per switch rated at 15 million cycles
X = No Timing Dial or dial window is to be provided
Warranty 3 years
With NEMA 4X Stainless Adder & 2.5 Inch Shaft Extension without woodruff key and keyslot
$3,511.00
1980-4500 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-R-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
With a special main shaft diameter, keyway & length. Ametek Gemco will assign an engineered part number once the order is acknowledged by engineering. Shaft diameter as it extends from the cam box, 18mm. Shaft keyway 6X3mm, Shaft length from mounting foot center line to end 86mm
$605.00
1980-4501 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-104-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed. Switches can be wired to be a Normally Open or Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS)
With a special main shaft diameter, keyway & length. Ametek Gemco will assign an engineered part number once the order is acknowledged by engineering. Shaft diameter as it extends from the cam box, 18mm. Shaft keyway 6X3mm, Shaft length from mounting foot center line to end 86mm In error provided DPDT switches, change engr # for SPDT switches
$717.00
1980-4504 Ametek Gemco Engineered Product. Same as part number 1980-4469 with the exception of the removal of the gear reducer. Mount and couple the customer supplied encoder. The encoder is to be a Dynapar Series A125-0012-1-C-320
304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, cover, latches, bearing flanges & flange bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating 406
17 to 20 Circuit Size Enclosure Dim
Also similar to a 1980-408-L-DP-TD1
(57LBS) 40 X 14 X 7 Box
$3,092.00
1980-4510 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model, similar to 1980-407-X-SP-R-S-100-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure. 316 Stainless Steel Enclosure, cover & latches. 304 SS for Bearing Flanges & Flange Bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating
07 = 7 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot option on Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
100 = 100 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer / Main Shaft
(34LBS)
$2,871.00
1980-4513 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 12 Rated Enclosure
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
Qty. 3, SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch. With Gold Plated Contacts
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Qty. 1, DPDT Switch, Located in Circuit / Position 4, Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch. With Gold Plated Contacts
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty 1/10
$1,123.74
1980-4514 Ametek Gemco Specially Engineered Product. Similar to part number 1980-916-Y-DP-X-S-8-R with enclosure heater and thermostat
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
9 = NEMA 9 Rated Enclosure
16 = 16 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Y = Double Shaft Extension from Enclosure, Two
DP = DPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits. 8 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial is to be supplied
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
8 = 8 to 1 Gear Ratio
R- Gear Box mounted on the Right Side
(85LBS)
$6,325.00
1980-4515 Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model like 1980-406-X-SP-X-SX-30-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension Opposite the Gear Box
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial
SX= Straight Drive Gear Reducer with a 1/2 Inch Diameter 316 Stainless Steel Shaft
30 = 30 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Shaft Location
$2,238.00
1980-4522 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model like a 1980-406-SP-R-X-TD2-R-20-L but with a 316 Stainless Steel Main Shaft
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Watertight Enclosure
06 = 6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No Shaft Extension opposite the gearbox
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot option on Switch Plunger for additional moisture protection
TD2 = Timing Dial Labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
R - Right Angle Gear Reducer with a 316 Stainless Steel Shaft
20 = 20 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Gear Box is located on the Left Side
(30LBS)
$4,168.00
1980-4527 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4X Stainless Steel Enclosure, Watertight. The 304 Stainless Steel includes the Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges, & Flange Bolts. The 3/4 Inch Diameter Main / Input Shaft is 316 Stainless. This construction meets a NEMA 4X Rating
6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw which can be wired for normally open or closed circuits, 4 screw terminals. Switch 1950-1-B-AO
Straight Drive Gear Multiplier with a 1 to 2 Ratio
Gear Multiplier Located on the Ring End 2/10
$3,316.00
1980-4528 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4X Enclosure, Stainless Steel Enclosure includes the Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges, & Flange Bolts from 304 Stainless Steel. The 3/4 Inch Diameter Main / Input Shaft is 316 Stainless. This construction meets a NEMA 4X Rating
10 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
Right Hand Shaft Extension
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty 1/11
$3,045.10
1980-4540 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
D = Double Shaft Extension from Enclosure, Two, Right & Left
GSP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch. With Gold Plated Contacts
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(12LBS) 11/7
$777.00
1980-4541 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-104-L-GSPR-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Rated Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension
GSPR = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch. With Gold Plated Contacts & Rubber Seals for additional dust & moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided (12LBS)
$727.00
1980-4542 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-103-L-GSPR-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
1 = NEMA 1 Enclosure
03 = 3 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension
GSPR = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch. With Gold Plated Contacts & Rubber Seals for additional dust & moisture protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided (11LBS) 10/8
$676.00
1980-4549 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model Like 1980-4X05-R-SP-R-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4X= NEMA 4X Rated Enclosure, Watertight, 304 Stainless Steel Option
05 = 5 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot / Seal on the Switch Plunger for additional moisture & dust protection
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(LBS)
$1,779.00
1980-4561 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
12 = NEMA 12 Enclosure
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
Qty. 3, SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Qty. 1, DP = DPDT Switches / Double Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 8 screw terminals per switch, circuit 4
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(18LBS) 8/8
$906.00
1980-4565 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell and a Resolver
Resolver Included with Output Compatible with all Gemco Electronic Modules 04535001
NEMA 4X Stainless Steel Enclosure, 304 Stainless Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges & Flange Bolts & a 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft
16 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
No Shaft Extension Opposite Gearbox
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Right Angle Gear Reducer
4 to 1 Gear Ratio
Gear Reducer on Right Side
Shaft Position No 1
$5,242.00
1980-4566 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-402-D-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
NEMA 4X Stainless Steel Enclosure, 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges & Flange Bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating
2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
Double Shaft Extension from enclosure, 2
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
(21LBS)
$1,306.61
1980-4569 Ametek Gemco 1980 Series Cam Limit Switch featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
2 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
Switch Settings @ 4 to 356 Degrees
Right Hand Shaft Extension
Gemco will mount and couple a customer supplied Synchro Differential Transmitter Type 23CDX6a Part 8212786 in the cambox enclosure
8 Circuit Size Enclosure with a 304 Stainless Steel, Cover, Latches, Bearing Flanges & Flange Bolts
3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft Manufacture to meet a NEMA 4X Rating
A separate conduit opening for the Synchro Wiring and Mechanical SPDT Switches
Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuits, 4 screw terminals per switch
Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Enclosure includes a thermostatically controlled strip heater
4 to 5 Weeks 5/9
$2,386.00
1980-4570 04-14-1380 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
NEMA 4 Rated Stainless Steel Enclosure. 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, cover, latches, bearing flanges & flange bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating
6 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
Rubber Boot on switch plunger for moisture & dust protection
Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty (36LBS)
$2,231.00
1980-4571 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Like Model 1980-4X04-R-SPR-TD2 & 1980-4387
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4 = NEMA 4 Rated Stainless Steel Enclosure 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, cover, latches, bearing flanges & flange bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating
04 = 4 Cams / Circuits / Switches
R = Right Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
R = Rubber Boot on switch plunger for moisture & dust protection
TD2 = Timing Dial labeled for Counter Clock Wise Rotation
Special: 304 stainless steel enclosure & 316 Stainless Steel Shaft
The enclosure is a 5-6 circuit size due to TD2 Timing dial Option
$1,742.00
1980-4572 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Like Model 1980-404-L-SPR-TD1
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
NEMA 4 Rated Stainless Steel Enclosure. 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, cover, latches, bearing flanges & flange bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating
4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
R = Rubber Boot on switch plunger for moisture & dust protection
TD1 = Timing Dial Labeled for C.W. Rotation
3 Year Limited Warranty
(23LBS)
$1,742.00
1980-4574 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch like Model 1980-404-X-SP-R-X-S-28-L
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4X = NEMA 4X Enclosure, 304 Stainless Steel Enclosure, cover, latches, bearing flanges & flange bolts. 3/4 Inch 316 Stainless Input Shaft. Meets a NEMA 4X Rating
04 = 4 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
X = No shaft extension opposite gearbox
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
S = Straight Drive Gear Reducer
28 = 28 to 1 Gear Ratio
L = Left End Gear Reducer
(24LBS) 8/9
$2,331.00
1980-4583 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch Model 1980-418X-L-SP-X
Series 1980 Cam Box featuring cams with Adjustable Timing & Dwell
4X = NEMA 4X Enclosure, Watertight,
18 = 18 Independent Cams / Circuits / Switches
The micro-adjust cams maintain an accuracy and repeatability of 1/4 degree and can be adjusted by use of a tool supplied and mounted inside the enclosure or by hand
L = Left Hand Shaft Extension from Enclosure
SP = SPDT Switches / Single Pole Double Throw, Snap Action, U.L. Listed Switches which can be wired for either a Normally Open or a Normally Closed Circuit. 4 screw terminals per switch
Switch Settings 4 to 356 Degrees - Gemco Manufactured Precision Snap Switches - UL Listed Assembly File E56660
X = No Timing Dial or Dial Window is to be provided
3 Year Limited Warranty
$4,582.00
1980-4592 Ametek Gemco Rotating Cam Limit Switch
Series 1980 Cam Box fea